* unexec.h: New file.
[bpt/emacs.git] / src / xterm.c
1 /* X Communication module for terminals which understand the X protocol.
2
3 Copyright (C) 1989, 1993-2011 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4
5 This file is part of GNU Emacs.
6
7 GNU Emacs is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
8 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
9 the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
10 (at your option) any later version.
11
12 GNU Emacs is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
13 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
14 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
15 GNU General Public License for more details.
16
17 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18 along with GNU Emacs. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */
19
20 /* New display code by Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>. */
21 /* Xt features made by Fred Pierresteguy. */
22
23 #include <config.h>
24 #include <signal.h>
25 #include <stdio.h>
26 #include <setjmp.h>
27
28 #ifdef HAVE_X_WINDOWS
29
30 #include "lisp.h"
31 #include "blockinput.h"
32
33 /* Need syssignal.h for various externs and definitions that may be required
34 by some configurations for calls to signal later in this source file. */
35 #include "syssignal.h"
36
37 /* This may include sys/types.h, and that somehow loses
38 if this is not done before the other system files. */
39 #include "xterm.h"
40 #include <X11/cursorfont.h>
41
42 /* Load sys/types.h if not already loaded.
43 In some systems loading it twice is suicidal. */
44 #ifndef makedev
45 #include <sys/types.h>
46 #endif /* makedev */
47
48 #include <sys/ioctl.h>
49
50 #include "systime.h"
51
52 #include <fcntl.h>
53 #include <ctype.h>
54 #include <errno.h>
55 #include <setjmp.h>
56 #include <sys/stat.h>
57 /* Caused redefinition of DBL_DIG on Netbsd; seems not to be needed. */
58 /* #include <sys/param.h> */
59
60 #include "charset.h"
61 #include "character.h"
62 #include "coding.h"
63 #include "frame.h"
64 #include "dispextern.h"
65 #include "fontset.h"
66 #include "termhooks.h"
67 #include "termopts.h"
68 #include "termchar.h"
69 #include "emacs-icon.h"
70 #include "disptab.h"
71 #include "buffer.h"
72 #include "window.h"
73 #include "keyboard.h"
74 #include "intervals.h"
75 #include "process.h"
76 #include "atimer.h"
77 #include "keymap.h"
78 #include "font.h"
79 #include "fontset.h"
80 #include "xsettings.h"
81 #include "xgselect.h"
82 #include "sysselect.h"
83
84 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
85 #include <X11/Shell.h>
86 #endif
87
88 #ifdef HAVE_SYS_TIME_H
89 #include <sys/time.h>
90 #endif
91
92 #include <unistd.h>
93
94 #ifdef USE_GTK
95 #include "gtkutil.h"
96 #endif
97
98 #ifdef USE_LUCID
99 #include "../lwlib/xlwmenu.h"
100 #endif
101
102 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
103 #if !defined(NO_EDITRES)
104 #define HACK_EDITRES
105 extern void _XEditResCheckMessages ();
106 #endif /* not NO_EDITRES */
107
108 /* Include toolkit specific headers for the scroll bar widget. */
109
110 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
111 #if defined USE_MOTIF
112 #include <Xm/Xm.h> /* for LESSTIF_VERSION */
113 #include <Xm/ScrollBar.h>
114 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
115
116 #ifdef HAVE_XAW3D
117 #include <X11/Xaw3d/Simple.h>
118 #include <X11/Xaw3d/Scrollbar.h>
119 #include <X11/Xaw3d/ThreeD.h>
120 #else /* !HAVE_XAW3D */
121 #include <X11/Xaw/Simple.h>
122 #include <X11/Xaw/Scrollbar.h>
123 #endif /* !HAVE_XAW3D */
124 #ifndef XtNpickTop
125 #define XtNpickTop "pickTop"
126 #endif /* !XtNpickTop */
127 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
128 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
129
130 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
131
132 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
133 #include "widget.h"
134 #ifndef XtNinitialState
135 #define XtNinitialState "initialState"
136 #endif
137 #endif
138
139 /* Default to using XIM if available. */
140 #ifdef USE_XIM
141 int use_xim = 1;
142 #else
143 int use_xim = 0; /* configure --without-xim */
144 #endif
145
146 \f
147
148 /* Non-zero means that a HELP_EVENT has been generated since Emacs
149 start. */
150
151 static int any_help_event_p;
152
153 /* Last window where we saw the mouse. Used by mouse-autoselect-window. */
154 static Lisp_Object last_window;
155
156 /* This is a chain of structures for all the X displays currently in
157 use. */
158
159 struct x_display_info *x_display_list;
160
161 /* This is a list of cons cells, each of the form (NAME
162 . FONT-LIST-CACHE), one for each element of x_display_list and in
163 the same order. NAME is the name of the frame. FONT-LIST-CACHE
164 records previous values returned by x-list-fonts. */
165
166 Lisp_Object x_display_name_list;
167
168 /* Frame being updated by update_frame. This is declared in term.c.
169 This is set by update_begin and looked at by all the XT functions.
170 It is zero while not inside an update. In that case, the XT
171 functions assume that `selected_frame' is the frame to apply to. */
172
173 extern struct frame *updating_frame;
174
175 /* This is a frame waiting to be auto-raised, within XTread_socket. */
176
177 static struct frame *pending_autoraise_frame;
178
179 /* This is a frame waiting for an event matching mask, within XTread_socket. */
180
181 static struct {
182 struct frame *f;
183 int eventtype;
184 } pending_event_wait;
185
186 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
187 /* The application context for Xt use. */
188 XtAppContext Xt_app_con;
189 static String Xt_default_resources[] = {0};
190 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
191
192 /* Non-zero means user is interacting with a toolkit scroll bar. */
193
194 static int toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction;
195
196 /* Non-zero timeout value means ignore next mouse click if it arrives
197 before that timeout elapses (i.e. as part of the same sequence of
198 events resulting from clicking on a frame to select it). */
199
200 static unsigned long ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout;
201
202 /* Mouse movement.
203
204 Formerly, we used PointerMotionHintMask (in standard_event_mask)
205 so that we would have to call XQueryPointer after each MotionNotify
206 event to ask for another such event. However, this made mouse tracking
207 slow, and there was a bug that made it eventually stop.
208
209 Simply asking for MotionNotify all the time seems to work better.
210
211 In order to avoid asking for motion events and then throwing most
212 of them away or busy-polling the server for mouse positions, we ask
213 the server for pointer motion hints. This means that we get only
214 one event per group of mouse movements. "Groups" are delimited by
215 other kinds of events (focus changes and button clicks, for
216 example), or by XQueryPointer calls; when one of these happens, we
217 get another MotionNotify event the next time the mouse moves. This
218 is at least as efficient as getting motion events when mouse
219 tracking is on, and I suspect only negligibly worse when tracking
220 is off. */
221
222 /* Where the mouse was last time we reported a mouse event. */
223
224 static XRectangle last_mouse_glyph;
225 static FRAME_PTR last_mouse_glyph_frame;
226 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_press_frame;
227
228 /* The scroll bar in which the last X motion event occurred.
229
230 If the last X motion event occurred in a scroll bar, we set this so
231 XTmouse_position can know whether to report a scroll bar motion or
232 an ordinary motion.
233
234 If the last X motion event didn't occur in a scroll bar, we set
235 this to Qnil, to tell XTmouse_position to return an ordinary motion
236 event. */
237
238 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_scroll_bar;
239
240 /* This is a hack. We would really prefer that XTmouse_position would
241 return the time associated with the position it returns, but there
242 doesn't seem to be any way to wrest the time-stamp from the server
243 along with the position query. So, we just keep track of the time
244 of the last movement we received, and return that in hopes that
245 it's somewhat accurate. */
246
247 static Time last_mouse_movement_time;
248
249 /* Time for last user interaction as returned in X events. */
250
251 static Time last_user_time;
252
253 /* Incremented by XTread_socket whenever it really tries to read
254 events. */
255
256 #ifdef __STDC__
257 static int volatile input_signal_count;
258 #else
259 static int input_signal_count;
260 #endif
261
262 /* Used locally within XTread_socket. */
263
264 static int x_noop_count;
265
266 static Lisp_Object Qalt, Qhyper, Qmeta, Qsuper, Qmodifier_value;
267
268 static Lisp_Object Qvendor_specific_keysyms;
269 static Lisp_Object Qlatin_1;
270
271 #ifdef USE_GTK
272 /* The name of the Emacs icon file. */
273 static Lisp_Object xg_default_icon_file;
274
275 /* Used in gtkutil.c. */
276 Lisp_Object Qx_gtk_map_stock;
277 #endif
278
279 /* Some functions take this as char *, not const char *. */
280 static char emacs_class[] = EMACS_CLASS;
281
282 enum xembed_info
283 {
284 XEMBED_MAPPED = 1 << 0
285 };
286
287 enum xembed_message
288 {
289 XEMBED_EMBEDDED_NOTIFY = 0,
290 XEMBED_WINDOW_ACTIVATE = 1,
291 XEMBED_WINDOW_DEACTIVATE = 2,
292 XEMBED_REQUEST_FOCUS = 3,
293 XEMBED_FOCUS_IN = 4,
294 XEMBED_FOCUS_OUT = 5,
295 XEMBED_FOCUS_NEXT = 6,
296 XEMBED_FOCUS_PREV = 7,
297
298 XEMBED_MODALITY_ON = 10,
299 XEMBED_MODALITY_OFF = 11,
300 XEMBED_REGISTER_ACCELERATOR = 12,
301 XEMBED_UNREGISTER_ACCELERATOR = 13,
302 XEMBED_ACTIVATE_ACCELERATOR = 14
303 };
304
305 /* Used in x_flush. */
306
307 static int x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (Display *, Colormap, XColor *);
308 static void x_set_window_size_1 (struct frame *, int, int, int);
309 static const XColor *x_color_cells (Display *, int *);
310 static void x_update_window_end (struct window *, int, int);
311
312 static int x_io_error_quitter (Display *);
313 static struct terminal *x_create_terminal (struct x_display_info *);
314 void x_delete_terminal (struct terminal *);
315 static void x_update_end (struct frame *);
316 static void XTframe_up_to_date (struct frame *);
317 static void XTset_terminal_modes (struct terminal *);
318 static void XTreset_terminal_modes (struct terminal *);
319 static void x_clear_frame (struct frame *);
320 static void x_ins_del_lines (struct frame *, int, int) NO_RETURN;
321 static void frame_highlight (struct frame *);
322 static void frame_unhighlight (struct frame *);
323 static void x_new_focus_frame (struct x_display_info *, struct frame *);
324 static void x_focus_changed (int, int, struct x_display_info *,
325 struct frame *, struct input_event *);
326 static void x_detect_focus_change (struct x_display_info *,
327 XEvent *, struct input_event *);
328 static void XTframe_rehighlight (struct frame *);
329 static void x_frame_rehighlight (struct x_display_info *);
330 static void x_draw_hollow_cursor (struct window *, struct glyph_row *);
331 static void x_draw_bar_cursor (struct window *, struct glyph_row *, int,
332 enum text_cursor_kinds);
333
334 static void x_clip_to_row (struct window *, struct glyph_row *, int, GC);
335 static void x_flush (struct frame *f);
336 static void x_update_begin (struct frame *);
337 static void x_update_window_begin (struct window *);
338 static void x_after_update_window_line (struct glyph_row *);
339 static struct scroll_bar *x_window_to_scroll_bar (Display *, Window);
340 static void x_scroll_bar_report_motion (struct frame **, Lisp_Object *,
341 enum scroll_bar_part *,
342 Lisp_Object *, Lisp_Object *,
343 unsigned long *);
344 static void x_handle_net_wm_state (struct frame *, XPropertyEvent *);
345 static void x_check_fullscreen (struct frame *);
346 static void x_check_expected_move (struct frame *, int, int);
347 static void x_sync_with_move (struct frame *, int, int, int);
348 static int handle_one_xevent (struct x_display_info *, XEvent *,
349 int *, struct input_event *);
350 /* Don't declare this NO_RETURN because we want no
351 interference with debugging failing X calls. */
352 static SIGTYPE x_connection_closed (Display *, const char *);
353
354
355 /* Flush display of frame F, or of all frames if F is null. */
356
357 static void
358 x_flush (struct frame *f)
359 {
360 /* Don't call XFlush when it is not safe to redisplay; the X
361 connection may be broken. */
362 if (!NILP (Vinhibit_redisplay))
363 return;
364
365 BLOCK_INPUT;
366 if (f == NULL)
367 {
368 Lisp_Object rest, frame;
369 FOR_EACH_FRAME (rest, frame)
370 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame)))
371 x_flush (XFRAME (frame));
372 }
373 else if (FRAME_X_P (f))
374 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
375 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
376 }
377
378
379 /* Remove calls to XFlush by defining XFlush to an empty replacement.
380 Calls to XFlush should be unnecessary because the X output buffer
381 is flushed automatically as needed by calls to XPending,
382 XNextEvent, or XWindowEvent according to the XFlush man page.
383 XTread_socket calls XPending. Removing XFlush improves
384 performance. */
385
386 #define XFlush(DISPLAY) (void) 0
387
388 \f
389 /***********************************************************************
390 Debugging
391 ***********************************************************************/
392
393 #if 0
394
395 /* This is a function useful for recording debugging information about
396 the sequence of occurrences in this file. */
397
398 struct record
399 {
400 char *locus;
401 int type;
402 };
403
404 struct record event_record[100];
405
406 int event_record_index;
407
408 void
409 record_event (char *locus, int type)
410 {
411 if (event_record_index == sizeof (event_record) / sizeof (struct record))
412 event_record_index = 0;
413
414 event_record[event_record_index].locus = locus;
415 event_record[event_record_index].type = type;
416 event_record_index++;
417 }
418
419 #endif /* 0 */
420
421
422 \f
423 /* Return the struct x_display_info corresponding to DPY. */
424
425 struct x_display_info *
426 x_display_info_for_display (Display *dpy)
427 {
428 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
429
430 for (dpyinfo = x_display_list; dpyinfo; dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next)
431 if (dpyinfo->display == dpy)
432 return dpyinfo;
433
434 return 0;
435 }
436
437 #define OPAQUE 0xffffffff
438
439 void
440 x_set_frame_alpha (struct frame *f)
441 {
442 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
443 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
444 Window win = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
445 double alpha = 1.0;
446 double alpha_min = 1.0;
447 unsigned long opac;
448
449 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window != FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->parent_desc)
450 /* Since the WM decoration lies under the FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW,
451 we must treat the former instead of the latter. */
452 win = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->parent_desc;
453
454 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame == f)
455 alpha = f->alpha[0];
456 else
457 alpha = f->alpha[1];
458
459 if (FLOATP (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit))
460 alpha_min = XFLOAT_DATA (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit);
461 else if (INTEGERP (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit))
462 alpha_min = (XINT (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit)) / 100.0;
463
464 if (alpha < 0.0)
465 return;
466 else if (alpha > 1.0)
467 alpha = 1.0;
468 else if (0.0 <= alpha && alpha < alpha_min && alpha_min <= 1.0)
469 alpha = alpha_min;
470
471 opac = alpha * OPAQUE;
472
473 /* return unless necessary */
474 {
475 unsigned char *data;
476 Atom actual;
477 int rc, format;
478 unsigned long n, left;
479
480 x_catch_errors (dpy);
481 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, win, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_window_opacity,
482 0L, 1L, False, XA_CARDINAL,
483 &actual, &format, &n, &left,
484 &data);
485
486 if (rc == Success && actual != None)
487 {
488 unsigned long value = *(unsigned long *)data;
489 XFree ((void *) data);
490 if (value == opac)
491 {
492 x_uncatch_errors ();
493 return;
494 }
495 }
496 }
497
498 XChangeProperty (dpy, win, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_window_opacity,
499 XA_CARDINAL, 32, PropModeReplace,
500 (unsigned char *) &opac, 1L);
501 x_uncatch_errors ();
502 }
503
504 int
505 x_display_pixel_height (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
506 {
507 return HeightOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
508 }
509
510 int
511 x_display_pixel_width (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
512 {
513 return WidthOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
514 }
515
516 \f
517 /***********************************************************************
518 Starting and ending an update
519 ***********************************************************************/
520
521 /* Start an update of frame F. This function is installed as a hook
522 for update_begin, i.e. it is called when update_begin is called.
523 This function is called prior to calls to x_update_window_begin for
524 each window being updated. Currently, there is nothing to do here
525 because all interesting stuff is done on a window basis. */
526
527 static void
528 x_update_begin (struct frame *f)
529 {
530 /* Nothing to do. */
531 }
532
533
534 /* Start update of window W. Set the global variable updated_window
535 to the window being updated and set output_cursor to the cursor
536 position of W. */
537
538 static void
539 x_update_window_begin (struct window *w)
540 {
541 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
542 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (f);
543
544 updated_window = w;
545 set_output_cursor (&w->cursor);
546
547 BLOCK_INPUT;
548
549 if (f == hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
550 {
551 /* Don't do highlighting for mouse motion during the update. */
552 hlinfo->mouse_face_defer = 1;
553
554 /* If F needs to be redrawn, simply forget about any prior mouse
555 highlighting. */
556 if (FRAME_GARBAGED_P (f))
557 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
558 }
559
560 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
561 }
562
563
564 /* Draw a vertical window border from (x,y0) to (x,y1) */
565
566 static void
567 x_draw_vertical_window_border (struct window *w, int x, int y0, int y1)
568 {
569 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
570 struct face *face;
571
572 face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, VERTICAL_BORDER_FACE_ID);
573 if (face)
574 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
575 face->foreground);
576
577 XDrawLine (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
578 f->output_data.x->normal_gc, x, y0, x, y1);
579 }
580
581 /* End update of window W (which is equal to updated_window).
582
583 Draw vertical borders between horizontally adjacent windows, and
584 display W's cursor if CURSOR_ON_P is non-zero.
585
586 MOUSE_FACE_OVERWRITTEN_P non-zero means that some row containing
587 glyphs in mouse-face were overwritten. In that case we have to
588 make sure that the mouse-highlight is properly redrawn.
589
590 W may be a menu bar pseudo-window in case we don't have X toolkit
591 support. Such windows don't have a cursor, so don't display it
592 here. */
593
594 static void
595 x_update_window_end (struct window *w, int cursor_on_p, int mouse_face_overwritten_p)
596 {
597 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (XFRAME (w->frame));
598
599 if (!w->pseudo_window_p)
600 {
601 BLOCK_INPUT;
602
603 if (cursor_on_p)
604 display_and_set_cursor (w, 1, output_cursor.hpos,
605 output_cursor.vpos,
606 output_cursor.x, output_cursor.y);
607
608 if (draw_window_fringes (w, 1))
609 x_draw_vertical_border (w);
610
611 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
612 }
613
614 /* If a row with mouse-face was overwritten, arrange for
615 XTframe_up_to_date to redisplay the mouse highlight. */
616 if (mouse_face_overwritten_p)
617 {
618 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
619 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
620 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
621 }
622
623 updated_window = NULL;
624 }
625
626
627 /* End update of frame F. This function is installed as a hook in
628 update_end. */
629
630 static void
631 x_update_end (struct frame *f)
632 {
633 /* Mouse highlight may be displayed again. */
634 MOUSE_HL_INFO (f)->mouse_face_defer = 0;
635
636 #ifndef XFlush
637 BLOCK_INPUT;
638 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
639 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
640 #endif
641 }
642
643
644 /* This function is called from various places in xdisp.c whenever a
645 complete update has been performed. The global variable
646 updated_window is not available here. */
647
648 static void
649 XTframe_up_to_date (struct frame *f)
650 {
651 if (FRAME_X_P (f))
652 {
653 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (f);
654
655 if (hlinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc
656 || f == hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
657 {
658 BLOCK_INPUT;
659 if (hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
660 note_mouse_highlight (hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame,
661 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_x,
662 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_y);
663 hlinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
664 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
665 }
666 }
667 }
668
669
670 /* Draw truncation mark bitmaps, continuation mark bitmaps, overlay
671 arrow bitmaps, or clear the fringes if no bitmaps are required
672 before DESIRED_ROW is made current. The window being updated is
673 found in updated_window. This function It is called from
674 update_window_line only if it is known that there are differences
675 between bitmaps to be drawn between current row and DESIRED_ROW. */
676
677 static void
678 x_after_update_window_line (struct glyph_row *desired_row)
679 {
680 struct window *w = updated_window;
681 struct frame *f;
682 int width, height;
683
684 xassert (w);
685
686 if (!desired_row->mode_line_p && !w->pseudo_window_p)
687 desired_row->redraw_fringe_bitmaps_p = 1;
688
689 /* When a window has disappeared, make sure that no rest of
690 full-width rows stays visible in the internal border. Could
691 check here if updated_window is the leftmost/rightmost window,
692 but I guess it's not worth doing since vertically split windows
693 are almost never used, internal border is rarely set, and the
694 overhead is very small. */
695 if (windows_or_buffers_changed
696 && desired_row->full_width_p
697 && (f = XFRAME (w->frame),
698 width = FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
699 width != 0)
700 && (height = desired_row->visible_height,
701 height > 0))
702 {
703 int y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (0, desired_row->y));
704
705 BLOCK_INPUT;
706 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
707 0, y, width, height, False);
708 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
709 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) - width,
710 y, width, height, False);
711 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
712 }
713 }
714
715 static void
716 x_draw_fringe_bitmap (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row, struct draw_fringe_bitmap_params *p)
717 {
718 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
719 Display *display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
720 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
721 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
722 struct face *face = p->face;
723
724 /* Must clip because of partially visible lines. */
725 x_clip_to_row (w, row, -1, gc);
726
727 if (!p->overlay_p)
728 {
729 int bx = p->bx, by = p->by, nx = p->nx, ny = p->ny;
730
731 /* In case the same realized face is used for fringes and
732 for something displayed in the text (e.g. face `region' on
733 mono-displays, the fill style may have been changed to
734 FillSolid in x_draw_glyph_string_background. */
735 if (face->stipple)
736 XSetFillStyle (display, face->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
737 else
738 XSetForeground (display, face->gc, face->background);
739
740 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
741 /* If the fringe is adjacent to the left (right) scroll bar of a
742 leftmost (rightmost, respectively) window, then extend its
743 background to the gap between the fringe and the bar. */
744 if ((WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w)
745 && WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
746 || (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w)
747 && WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w)))
748 {
749 int sb_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w);
750
751 if (sb_width > 0)
752 {
753 int left = WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_X (w);
754 int width = (WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w)
755 * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f));
756
757 if (bx < 0)
758 {
759 /* Bitmap fills the fringe. */
760 if (left + width == p->x)
761 bx = left + sb_width;
762 else if (p->x + p->wd == left)
763 bx = left;
764 if (bx >= 0)
765 {
766 int header_line_height = WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
767
768 nx = width - sb_width;
769 by = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (header_line_height,
770 row->y));
771 ny = row->visible_height;
772 }
773 }
774 else
775 {
776 if (left + width == bx)
777 {
778 bx = left + sb_width;
779 nx += width - sb_width;
780 }
781 else if (bx + nx == left)
782 nx += width - sb_width;
783 }
784 }
785 }
786 #endif
787 if (bx >= 0 && nx > 0)
788 XFillRectangle (display, window, face->gc, bx, by, nx, ny);
789
790 if (!face->stipple)
791 XSetForeground (display, face->gc, face->foreground);
792 }
793
794 if (p->which)
795 {
796 char *bits;
797 Pixmap pixmap, clipmask = (Pixmap) 0;
798 int depth = DefaultDepthOfScreen (FRAME_X_SCREEN (f));
799 XGCValues gcv;
800
801 if (p->wd > 8)
802 bits = (char *) (p->bits + p->dh);
803 else
804 bits = (char *) p->bits + p->dh;
805
806 /* Draw the bitmap. I believe these small pixmaps can be cached
807 by the server. */
808 pixmap = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (display, window, bits, p->wd, p->h,
809 (p->cursor_p
810 ? (p->overlay_p ? face->background
811 : f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel)
812 : face->foreground),
813 face->background, depth);
814
815 if (p->overlay_p)
816 {
817 clipmask = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (display,
818 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window,
819 bits, p->wd, p->h,
820 1, 0, 1);
821 gcv.clip_mask = clipmask;
822 gcv.clip_x_origin = p->x;
823 gcv.clip_y_origin = p->y;
824 XChangeGC (display, gc, GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin, &gcv);
825 }
826
827 XCopyArea (display, pixmap, window, gc, 0, 0,
828 p->wd, p->h, p->x, p->y);
829 XFreePixmap (display, pixmap);
830
831 if (p->overlay_p)
832 {
833 gcv.clip_mask = (Pixmap) 0;
834 XChangeGC (display, gc, GCClipMask, &gcv);
835 XFreePixmap (display, clipmask);
836 }
837 }
838
839 XSetClipMask (display, gc, None);
840 }
841
842 \f
843
844 /* This is called when starting Emacs and when restarting after
845 suspend. When starting Emacs, no X window is mapped. And nothing
846 must be done to Emacs's own window if it is suspended (though that
847 rarely happens). */
848
849 static void
850 XTset_terminal_modes (struct terminal *terminal)
851 {
852 }
853
854 /* This is called when exiting or suspending Emacs. Exiting will make
855 the X-windows go away, and suspending requires no action. */
856
857 static void
858 XTreset_terminal_modes (struct terminal *terminal)
859 {
860 }
861
862 \f
863 /***********************************************************************
864 Glyph display
865 ***********************************************************************/
866
867
868
869 static void x_set_glyph_string_clipping (struct glyph_string *);
870 static void x_set_glyph_string_gc (struct glyph_string *);
871 static void x_draw_glyph_string_background (struct glyph_string *,
872 int);
873 static void x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *);
874 static void x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *);
875 static void x_draw_glyph_string_box (struct glyph_string *);
876 static void x_draw_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *);
877 static void x_delete_glyphs (struct frame *, int) NO_RETURN;
878 static void x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs (struct glyph_string *);
879 static void x_set_cursor_gc (struct glyph_string *);
880 static void x_set_mode_line_face_gc (struct glyph_string *);
881 static void x_set_mouse_face_gc (struct glyph_string *);
882 static int x_alloc_lighter_color (struct frame *, Display *, Colormap,
883 unsigned long *, double, int);
884 static void x_setup_relief_color (struct frame *, struct relief *,
885 double, int, unsigned long);
886 static void x_setup_relief_colors (struct glyph_string *);
887 static void x_draw_image_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *);
888 static void x_draw_image_relief (struct glyph_string *);
889 static void x_draw_image_foreground (struct glyph_string *);
890 static void x_draw_image_foreground_1 (struct glyph_string *, Pixmap);
891 static void x_clear_glyph_string_rect (struct glyph_string *, int,
892 int, int, int);
893 static void x_draw_relief_rect (struct frame *, int, int, int, int,
894 int, int, int, int, int, int,
895 XRectangle *);
896 static void x_draw_box_rect (struct glyph_string *, int, int, int, int,
897 int, int, int, XRectangle *);
898 static void x_scroll_bar_clear (struct frame *);
899
900 #if GLYPH_DEBUG
901 static void x_check_font (struct frame *, struct font *);
902 #endif
903
904
905 /* Set S->gc to a suitable GC for drawing glyph string S in cursor
906 face. */
907
908 static void
909 x_set_cursor_gc (struct glyph_string *s)
910 {
911 if (s->font == FRAME_FONT (s->f)
912 && s->face->background == FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (s->f)
913 && s->face->foreground == FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (s->f)
914 && !s->cmp)
915 s->gc = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_gc;
916 else
917 {
918 /* Cursor on non-default face: must merge. */
919 XGCValues xgcv;
920 unsigned long mask;
921
922 xgcv.background = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
923 xgcv.foreground = s->face->background;
924
925 /* If the glyph would be invisible, try a different foreground. */
926 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
927 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
928 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
929 xgcv.foreground = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_foreground_pixel;
930 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
931 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
932
933 /* Make sure the cursor is distinct from text in this face. */
934 if (xgcv.background == s->face->background
935 && xgcv.foreground == s->face->foreground)
936 {
937 xgcv.background = s->face->foreground;
938 xgcv.foreground = s->face->background;
939 }
940
941 IF_DEBUG (x_check_font (s->f, s->font));
942 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
943 mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCGraphicsExposures;
944
945 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc)
946 XChangeGC (s->display, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc,
947 mask, &xgcv);
948 else
949 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc
950 = XCreateGC (s->display, s->window, mask, &xgcv);
951
952 s->gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
953 }
954 }
955
956
957 /* Set up S->gc of glyph string S for drawing text in mouse face. */
958
959 static void
960 x_set_mouse_face_gc (struct glyph_string *s)
961 {
962 int face_id;
963 struct face *face;
964
965 /* What face has to be used last for the mouse face? */
966 face_id = MOUSE_HL_INFO (s->f)->mouse_face_face_id;
967 face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
968 if (face == NULL)
969 face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, MOUSE_FACE_ID);
970
971 if (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
972 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (s->f, face, s->first_glyph->u.ch, -1, Qnil);
973 else
974 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (s->f, face, 0, -1, Qnil);
975 s->face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
976 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (s->f, s->face);
977
978 if (s->font == s->face->font)
979 s->gc = s->face->gc;
980 else
981 {
982 /* Otherwise construct scratch_cursor_gc with values from FACE
983 except for FONT. */
984 XGCValues xgcv;
985 unsigned long mask;
986
987 xgcv.background = s->face->background;
988 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
989 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
990 mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCGraphicsExposures;
991
992 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc)
993 XChangeGC (s->display, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc,
994 mask, &xgcv);
995 else
996 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc
997 = XCreateGC (s->display, s->window, mask, &xgcv);
998
999 s->gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
1000
1001 }
1002 xassert (s->gc != 0);
1003 }
1004
1005
1006 /* Set S->gc of glyph string S to a GC suitable for drawing a mode line.
1007 Faces to use in the mode line have already been computed when the
1008 matrix was built, so there isn't much to do, here. */
1009
1010 static INLINE void
1011 x_set_mode_line_face_gc (struct glyph_string *s)
1012 {
1013 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1014 }
1015
1016
1017 /* Set S->gc of glyph string S for drawing that glyph string. Set
1018 S->stippled_p to a non-zero value if the face of S has a stipple
1019 pattern. */
1020
1021 static INLINE void
1022 x_set_glyph_string_gc (struct glyph_string *s)
1023 {
1024 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (s->f, s->face);
1025
1026 if (s->hl == DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT)
1027 {
1028 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1029 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1030 }
1031 else if (s->hl == DRAW_INVERSE_VIDEO)
1032 {
1033 x_set_mode_line_face_gc (s);
1034 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1035 }
1036 else if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
1037 {
1038 x_set_cursor_gc (s);
1039 s->stippled_p = 0;
1040 }
1041 else if (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE)
1042 {
1043 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s);
1044 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1045 }
1046 else if (s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
1047 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN)
1048 {
1049 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1050 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1051 }
1052 else
1053 {
1054 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1055 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1056 }
1057
1058 /* GC must have been set. */
1059 xassert (s->gc != 0);
1060 }
1061
1062
1063 /* Set clipping for output of glyph string S. S may be part of a mode
1064 line or menu if we don't have X toolkit support. */
1065
1066 static INLINE void
1067 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (struct glyph_string *s)
1068 {
1069 XRectangle *r = s->clip;
1070 int n = get_glyph_string_clip_rects (s, r, 2);
1071
1072 if (n > 0)
1073 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, r, n, Unsorted);
1074 s->num_clips = n;
1075 }
1076
1077
1078 /* Set SRC's clipping for output of glyph string DST. This is called
1079 when we are drawing DST's left_overhang or right_overhang only in
1080 the area of SRC. */
1081
1082 static void
1083 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (struct glyph_string *src, struct glyph_string *dst)
1084 {
1085 XRectangle r;
1086
1087 r.x = src->x;
1088 r.width = src->width;
1089 r.y = src->y;
1090 r.height = src->height;
1091 dst->clip[0] = r;
1092 dst->num_clips = 1;
1093 XSetClipRectangles (dst->display, dst->gc, 0, 0, &r, 1, Unsorted);
1094 }
1095
1096
1097 /* RIF:
1098 Compute left and right overhang of glyph string S. */
1099
1100 static void
1101 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs (struct glyph_string *s)
1102 {
1103 if (s->cmp == NULL
1104 && (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
1105 || s->first_glyph->type == COMPOSITE_GLYPH))
1106 {
1107 struct font_metrics metrics;
1108
1109 if (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
1110 {
1111 unsigned *code = alloca (sizeof (unsigned) * s->nchars);
1112 struct font *font = s->font;
1113 int i;
1114
1115 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; i++)
1116 code[i] = (s->char2b[i].byte1 << 8) | s->char2b[i].byte2;
1117 font->driver->text_extents (font, code, s->nchars, &metrics);
1118 }
1119 else
1120 {
1121 Lisp_Object gstring = composition_gstring_from_id (s->cmp_id);
1122
1123 composition_gstring_width (gstring, s->cmp_from, s->cmp_to, &metrics);
1124 }
1125 s->right_overhang = (metrics.rbearing > metrics.width
1126 ? metrics.rbearing - metrics.width : 0);
1127 s->left_overhang = metrics.lbearing < 0 ? - metrics.lbearing : 0;
1128 }
1129 else if (s->cmp)
1130 {
1131 s->right_overhang = s->cmp->rbearing - s->cmp->pixel_width;
1132 s->left_overhang = - s->cmp->lbearing;
1133 }
1134 }
1135
1136
1137 /* Fill rectangle X, Y, W, H with background color of glyph string S. */
1138
1139 static INLINE void
1140 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (struct glyph_string *s, int x, int y, int w, int h)
1141 {
1142 XGCValues xgcv;
1143 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground | GCBackground, &xgcv);
1144 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.background);
1145 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y, w, h);
1146 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
1147 }
1148
1149
1150 /* Draw the background of glyph_string S. If S->background_filled_p
1151 is non-zero don't draw it. FORCE_P non-zero means draw the
1152 background even if it wouldn't be drawn normally. This is used
1153 when a string preceding S draws into the background of S, or S
1154 contains the first component of a composition. */
1155
1156 static void
1157 x_draw_glyph_string_background (struct glyph_string *s, int force_p)
1158 {
1159 /* Nothing to do if background has already been drawn or if it
1160 shouldn't be drawn in the first place. */
1161 if (!s->background_filled_p)
1162 {
1163 int box_line_width = max (s->face->box_line_width, 0);
1164
1165 if (s->stippled_p)
1166 {
1167 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
1168 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
1169 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x,
1170 s->y + box_line_width,
1171 s->background_width,
1172 s->height - 2 * box_line_width);
1173 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
1174 s->background_filled_p = 1;
1175 }
1176 else if (FONT_HEIGHT (s->font) < s->height - 2 * box_line_width
1177 || s->font_not_found_p
1178 || s->extends_to_end_of_line_p
1179 || force_p)
1180 {
1181 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, s->x, s->y + box_line_width,
1182 s->background_width,
1183 s->height - 2 * box_line_width);
1184 s->background_filled_p = 1;
1185 }
1186 }
1187 }
1188
1189
1190 /* Draw the foreground of glyph string S. */
1191
1192 static void
1193 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *s)
1194 {
1195 int i, x;
1196
1197 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1198 of S to the right of that box line. */
1199 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1200 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1201 x = s->x + eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
1202 else
1203 x = s->x;
1204
1205 /* Draw characters of S as rectangles if S's font could not be
1206 loaded. */
1207 if (s->font_not_found_p)
1208 {
1209 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; ++i)
1210 {
1211 struct glyph *g = s->first_glyph + i;
1212 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window,
1213 s->gc, x, s->y, g->pixel_width - 1,
1214 s->height - 1);
1215 x += g->pixel_width;
1216 }
1217 }
1218 else
1219 {
1220 struct font *font = s->font;
1221 int boff = font->baseline_offset;
1222 int y;
1223
1224 if (font->vertical_centering)
1225 boff = VCENTER_BASELINE_OFFSET (font, s->f) - boff;
1226
1227 y = s->ybase - boff;
1228 if (s->for_overlaps
1229 || (s->background_filled_p && s->hl != DRAW_CURSOR))
1230 font->driver->draw (s, 0, s->nchars, x, y, 0);
1231 else
1232 font->driver->draw (s, 0, s->nchars, x, y, 1);
1233 if (s->face->overstrike)
1234 font->driver->draw (s, 0, s->nchars, x + 1, y, 0);
1235 }
1236 }
1237
1238 /* Draw the foreground of composite glyph string S. */
1239
1240 static void
1241 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *s)
1242 {
1243 int i, j, x;
1244 struct font *font = s->font;
1245
1246 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1247 of S to the right of that box line. */
1248 if (s->face && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1249 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1250 x = s->x + eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
1251 else
1252 x = s->x;
1253
1254 /* S is a glyph string for a composition. S->cmp_from is the index
1255 of the first character drawn for glyphs of this composition.
1256 S->cmp_from == 0 means we are drawing the very first character of
1257 this composition. */
1258
1259 /* Draw a rectangle for the composition if the font for the very
1260 first character of the composition could not be loaded. */
1261 if (s->font_not_found_p)
1262 {
1263 if (s->cmp_from == 0)
1264 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, s->y,
1265 s->width - 1, s->height - 1);
1266 }
1267 else if (! s->first_glyph->u.cmp.automatic)
1268 {
1269 int y = s->ybase;
1270
1271 for (i = 0, j = s->cmp_from; i < s->nchars; i++, j++)
1272 if (COMPOSITION_GLYPH (s->cmp, j) != '\t')
1273 {
1274 int xx = x + s->cmp->offsets[j * 2];
1275 int yy = y - s->cmp->offsets[j * 2 + 1];
1276
1277 font->driver->draw (s, j, j + 1, xx, yy, 0);
1278 if (s->face->overstrike)
1279 font->driver->draw (s, j, j + 1, xx + 1, yy, 0);
1280 }
1281 }
1282 else
1283 {
1284 Lisp_Object gstring = composition_gstring_from_id (s->cmp_id);
1285 Lisp_Object glyph;
1286 int y = s->ybase;
1287 int width = 0;
1288
1289 for (i = j = s->cmp_from; i < s->cmp_to; i++)
1290 {
1291 glyph = LGSTRING_GLYPH (gstring, i);
1292 if (NILP (LGLYPH_ADJUSTMENT (glyph)))
1293 width += LGLYPH_WIDTH (glyph);
1294 else
1295 {
1296 int xoff, yoff, wadjust;
1297
1298 if (j < i)
1299 {
1300 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x, y, 0);
1301 if (s->face->overstrike)
1302 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x + 1, y, 0);
1303 x += width;
1304 }
1305 xoff = LGLYPH_XOFF (glyph);
1306 yoff = LGLYPH_YOFF (glyph);
1307 wadjust = LGLYPH_WADJUST (glyph);
1308 font->driver->draw (s, i, i + 1, x + xoff, y + yoff, 0);
1309 if (s->face->overstrike)
1310 font->driver->draw (s, i, i + 1, x + xoff + 1, y + yoff, 0);
1311 x += wadjust;
1312 j = i + 1;
1313 width = 0;
1314 }
1315 }
1316 if (j < i)
1317 {
1318 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x, y, 0);
1319 if (s->face->overstrike)
1320 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x + 1, y, 0);
1321 }
1322 }
1323 }
1324
1325
1326 /* Draw the foreground of glyph string S for glyphless characters. */
1327
1328 static void
1329 x_draw_glyphless_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *s)
1330 {
1331 struct glyph *glyph = s->first_glyph;
1332 XChar2b char2b[8];
1333 int x, i, j;
1334
1335 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1336 of S to the right of that box line. */
1337 if (s->face && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1338 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1339 x = s->x + eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
1340 else
1341 x = s->x;
1342
1343 s->char2b = char2b;
1344
1345 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; i++, glyph++)
1346 {
1347 char buf[7], *str = NULL;
1348 int len = glyph->u.glyphless.len;
1349
1350 if (glyph->u.glyphless.method == GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_ACRONYM)
1351 {
1352 if (len > 0
1353 && CHAR_TABLE_P (Vglyphless_char_display)
1354 && (CHAR_TABLE_EXTRA_SLOTS (XCHAR_TABLE (Vglyphless_char_display))
1355 >= 1))
1356 {
1357 Lisp_Object acronym
1358 = (! glyph->u.glyphless.for_no_font
1359 ? CHAR_TABLE_REF (Vglyphless_char_display,
1360 glyph->u.glyphless.ch)
1361 : XCHAR_TABLE (Vglyphless_char_display)->extras[0]);
1362 if (STRINGP (acronym))
1363 str = SSDATA (acronym);
1364 }
1365 }
1366 else if (glyph->u.glyphless.method == GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_HEX_CODE)
1367 {
1368 sprintf ((char *) buf, "%0*X",
1369 glyph->u.glyphless.ch < 0x10000 ? 4 : 6,
1370 glyph->u.glyphless.ch);
1371 str = buf;
1372 }
1373
1374 if (str)
1375 {
1376 int upper_len = (len + 1) / 2;
1377 unsigned code;
1378
1379 /* It is assured that all LEN characters in STR is ASCII. */
1380 for (j = 0; j < len; j++)
1381 {
1382 code = s->font->driver->encode_char (s->font, str[j]);
1383 STORE_XCHAR2B (char2b + j, code >> 8, code & 0xFF);
1384 }
1385 s->font->driver->draw (s, 0, upper_len,
1386 x + glyph->slice.glyphless.upper_xoff,
1387 s->ybase + glyph->slice.glyphless.upper_yoff,
1388 0);
1389 s->font->driver->draw (s, upper_len, len,
1390 x + glyph->slice.glyphless.lower_xoff,
1391 s->ybase + glyph->slice.glyphless.lower_yoff,
1392 0);
1393 }
1394 if (glyph->u.glyphless.method != GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_THIN_SPACE)
1395 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
1396 x, s->ybase - glyph->ascent,
1397 glyph->pixel_width - 1,
1398 glyph->ascent + glyph->descent - 1);
1399 x += glyph->pixel_width;
1400 }
1401 }
1402
1403 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
1404
1405 static struct frame *x_frame_of_widget (Widget);
1406 static Boolean cvt_string_to_pixel (Display *, XrmValue *, Cardinal *,
1407 XrmValue *, XrmValue *, XtPointer *);
1408 static void cvt_pixel_dtor (XtAppContext, XrmValue *, XtPointer,
1409 XrmValue *, Cardinal *);
1410
1411
1412 /* Return the frame on which widget WIDGET is used.. Abort if frame
1413 cannot be determined. */
1414
1415 static struct frame *
1416 x_frame_of_widget (Widget widget)
1417 {
1418 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
1419 Lisp_Object tail;
1420 struct frame *f;
1421
1422 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (XtDisplay (widget));
1423
1424 /* Find the top-level shell of the widget. Note that this function
1425 can be called when the widget is not yet realized, so XtWindow
1426 (widget) == 0. That's the reason we can't simply use
1427 x_any_window_to_frame. */
1428 while (!XtIsTopLevelShell (widget))
1429 widget = XtParent (widget);
1430
1431 /* Look for a frame with that top-level widget. Allocate the color
1432 on that frame to get the right gamma correction value. */
1433 for (tail = Vframe_list; CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
1434 if (FRAMEP (XCAR (tail))
1435 && (f = XFRAME (XCAR (tail)),
1436 (FRAME_X_P (f)
1437 && f->output_data.nothing != 1
1438 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == dpyinfo))
1439 && f->output_data.x->widget == widget)
1440 return f;
1441
1442 abort ();
1443 }
1444
1445
1446 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on the screen and display of
1447 widget WIDGET in colormap CMAP. If an exact match cannot be
1448 allocated, try the nearest color available. Value is non-zero
1449 if successful. This is called from lwlib. */
1450
1451 int
1452 x_alloc_nearest_color_for_widget (Widget widget, Colormap cmap, XColor *color)
1453 {
1454 struct frame *f = x_frame_of_widget (widget);
1455 return x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, color);
1456 }
1457
1458
1459 /* Allocate a color which is lighter or darker than *PIXEL by FACTOR
1460 or DELTA. Try a color with RGB values multiplied by FACTOR first.
1461 If this produces the same color as PIXEL, try a color where all RGB
1462 values have DELTA added. Return the allocated color in *PIXEL.
1463 DISPLAY is the X display, CMAP is the colormap to operate on.
1464 Value is non-zero if successful. */
1465
1466 int
1467 x_alloc_lighter_color_for_widget (Widget widget, Display *display, Colormap cmap,
1468 unsigned long *pixel, double factor, int delta)
1469 {
1470 struct frame *f = x_frame_of_widget (widget);
1471 return x_alloc_lighter_color (f, display, cmap, pixel, factor, delta);
1472 }
1473
1474
1475 /* Structure specifying which arguments should be passed by Xt to
1476 cvt_string_to_pixel. We want the widget's screen and colormap. */
1477
1478 static XtConvertArgRec cvt_string_to_pixel_args[] =
1479 {
1480 {XtWidgetBaseOffset, (XtPointer) XtOffset (Widget, core.screen),
1481 sizeof (Screen *)},
1482 {XtWidgetBaseOffset, (XtPointer) XtOffset (Widget, core.colormap),
1483 sizeof (Colormap)}
1484 };
1485
1486
1487 /* The address of this variable is returned by
1488 cvt_string_to_pixel. */
1489
1490 static Pixel cvt_string_to_pixel_value;
1491
1492
1493 /* Convert a color name to a pixel color.
1494
1495 DPY is the display we are working on.
1496
1497 ARGS is an array of *NARGS XrmValue structures holding additional
1498 information about the widget for which the conversion takes place.
1499 The contents of this array are determined by the specification
1500 in cvt_string_to_pixel_args.
1501
1502 FROM is a pointer to an XrmValue which points to the color name to
1503 convert. TO is an XrmValue in which to return the pixel color.
1504
1505 CLOSURE_RET is a pointer to user-data, in which we record if
1506 we allocated the color or not.
1507
1508 Value is True if successful, False otherwise. */
1509
1510 static Boolean
1511 cvt_string_to_pixel (Display *dpy, XrmValue *args, Cardinal *nargs,
1512 XrmValue *from, XrmValue *to,
1513 XtPointer *closure_ret)
1514 {
1515 Screen *screen;
1516 Colormap cmap;
1517 Pixel pixel;
1518 String color_name;
1519 XColor color;
1520
1521 if (*nargs != 2)
1522 {
1523 XtAppWarningMsg (XtDisplayToApplicationContext (dpy),
1524 "wrongParameters", "cvt_string_to_pixel",
1525 "XtToolkitError",
1526 "Screen and colormap args required", NULL, NULL);
1527 return False;
1528 }
1529
1530 screen = *(Screen **) args[0].addr;
1531 cmap = *(Colormap *) args[1].addr;
1532 color_name = (String) from->addr;
1533
1534 if (strcmp (color_name, XtDefaultBackground) == 0)
1535 {
1536 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) False;
1537 pixel = WhitePixelOfScreen (screen);
1538 }
1539 else if (strcmp (color_name, XtDefaultForeground) == 0)
1540 {
1541 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) False;
1542 pixel = BlackPixelOfScreen (screen);
1543 }
1544 else if (XParseColor (dpy, cmap, color_name, &color)
1545 && x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (dpy, cmap, &color))
1546 {
1547 pixel = color.pixel;
1548 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) True;
1549 }
1550 else
1551 {
1552 String params[1];
1553 Cardinal nparams = 1;
1554
1555 params[0] = color_name;
1556 XtAppWarningMsg (XtDisplayToApplicationContext (dpy),
1557 "badValue", "cvt_string_to_pixel",
1558 "XtToolkitError", "Invalid color `%s'",
1559 params, &nparams);
1560 return False;
1561 }
1562
1563 if (to->addr != NULL)
1564 {
1565 if (to->size < sizeof (Pixel))
1566 {
1567 to->size = sizeof (Pixel);
1568 return False;
1569 }
1570
1571 *(Pixel *) to->addr = pixel;
1572 }
1573 else
1574 {
1575 cvt_string_to_pixel_value = pixel;
1576 to->addr = (XtPointer) &cvt_string_to_pixel_value;
1577 }
1578
1579 to->size = sizeof (Pixel);
1580 return True;
1581 }
1582
1583
1584 /* Free a pixel color which was previously allocated via
1585 cvt_string_to_pixel. This is registered as the destructor
1586 for this type of resource via XtSetTypeConverter.
1587
1588 APP is the application context in which we work.
1589
1590 TO is a pointer to an XrmValue holding the color to free.
1591 CLOSURE is the value we stored in CLOSURE_RET for this color
1592 in cvt_string_to_pixel.
1593
1594 ARGS and NARGS are like for cvt_string_to_pixel. */
1595
1596 static void
1597 cvt_pixel_dtor (XtAppContext app, XrmValuePtr to, XtPointer closure, XrmValuePtr args,
1598 Cardinal *nargs)
1599 {
1600 if (*nargs != 2)
1601 {
1602 XtAppWarningMsg (app, "wrongParameters", "cvt_pixel_dtor",
1603 "XtToolkitError",
1604 "Screen and colormap arguments required",
1605 NULL, NULL);
1606 }
1607 else if (closure != NULL)
1608 {
1609 /* We did allocate the pixel, so free it. */
1610 Screen *screen = *(Screen **) args[0].addr;
1611 Colormap cmap = *(Colormap *) args[1].addr;
1612 x_free_dpy_colors (DisplayOfScreen (screen), screen, cmap,
1613 (Pixel *) to->addr, 1);
1614 }
1615 }
1616
1617
1618 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
1619
1620
1621 /* Value is an array of XColor structures for the contents of the
1622 color map of display DPY. Set *NCELLS to the size of the array.
1623 Note that this probably shouldn't be called for large color maps,
1624 say a 24-bit TrueColor map. */
1625
1626 static const XColor *
1627 x_color_cells (Display *dpy, int *ncells)
1628 {
1629 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
1630
1631 if (dpyinfo->color_cells == NULL)
1632 {
1633 Screen *screen = dpyinfo->screen;
1634 int i;
1635
1636 dpyinfo->ncolor_cells
1637 = XDisplayCells (dpy, XScreenNumberOfScreen (screen));
1638 dpyinfo->color_cells
1639 = (XColor *) xmalloc (dpyinfo->ncolor_cells
1640 * sizeof *dpyinfo->color_cells);
1641
1642 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->ncolor_cells; ++i)
1643 dpyinfo->color_cells[i].pixel = i;
1644
1645 XQueryColors (dpy, dpyinfo->cmap,
1646 dpyinfo->color_cells, dpyinfo->ncolor_cells);
1647 }
1648
1649 *ncells = dpyinfo->ncolor_cells;
1650 return dpyinfo->color_cells;
1651 }
1652
1653
1654 /* On frame F, translate pixel colors to RGB values for the NCOLORS
1655 colors in COLORS. Use cached information, if available. */
1656
1657 void
1658 x_query_colors (struct frame *f, XColor *colors, int ncolors)
1659 {
1660 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
1661
1662 if (dpyinfo->color_cells)
1663 {
1664 int i;
1665 for (i = 0; i < ncolors; ++i)
1666 {
1667 unsigned long pixel = colors[i].pixel;
1668 xassert (pixel < dpyinfo->ncolor_cells);
1669 xassert (dpyinfo->color_cells[pixel].pixel == pixel);
1670 colors[i] = dpyinfo->color_cells[pixel];
1671 }
1672 }
1673 else
1674 XQueryColors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f), colors, ncolors);
1675 }
1676
1677
1678 /* On frame F, translate pixel color to RGB values for the color in
1679 COLOR. Use cached information, if available. */
1680
1681 void
1682 x_query_color (struct frame *f, XColor *color)
1683 {
1684 x_query_colors (f, color, 1);
1685 }
1686
1687
1688 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on DISPLAY, colormap CMAP. If an
1689 exact match can't be allocated, try the nearest color available.
1690 Value is non-zero if successful. Set *COLOR to the color
1691 allocated. */
1692
1693 static int
1694 x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (Display *dpy, Colormap cmap, XColor *color)
1695 {
1696 int rc;
1697
1698 rc = XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, color);
1699 if (rc == 0)
1700 {
1701 /* If we got to this point, the colormap is full, so we're going
1702 to try to get the next closest color. The algorithm used is
1703 a least-squares matching, which is what X uses for closest
1704 color matching with StaticColor visuals. */
1705 int nearest, i;
1706 unsigned long nearest_delta = ~ (unsigned long) 0;
1707 int ncells;
1708 const XColor *cells = x_color_cells (dpy, &ncells);
1709
1710 for (nearest = i = 0; i < ncells; ++i)
1711 {
1712 long dred = (color->red >> 8) - (cells[i].red >> 8);
1713 long dgreen = (color->green >> 8) - (cells[i].green >> 8);
1714 long dblue = (color->blue >> 8) - (cells[i].blue >> 8);
1715 unsigned long delta = dred * dred + dgreen * dgreen + dblue * dblue;
1716
1717 if (delta < nearest_delta)
1718 {
1719 nearest = i;
1720 nearest_delta = delta;
1721 }
1722 }
1723
1724 color->red = cells[nearest].red;
1725 color->green = cells[nearest].green;
1726 color->blue = cells[nearest].blue;
1727 rc = XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, color);
1728 }
1729 else
1730 {
1731 /* If allocation succeeded, and the allocated pixel color is not
1732 equal to a cached pixel color recorded earlier, there was a
1733 change in the colormap, so clear the color cache. */
1734 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
1735 XColor *cached_color;
1736
1737 if (dpyinfo->color_cells
1738 && (cached_color = &dpyinfo->color_cells[color->pixel],
1739 (cached_color->red != color->red
1740 || cached_color->blue != color->blue
1741 || cached_color->green != color->green)))
1742 {
1743 xfree (dpyinfo->color_cells);
1744 dpyinfo->color_cells = NULL;
1745 dpyinfo->ncolor_cells = 0;
1746 }
1747 }
1748
1749 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1750 if (rc)
1751 register_color (color->pixel);
1752 #endif /* DEBUG_X_COLORS */
1753
1754 return rc;
1755 }
1756
1757
1758 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on frame F, colormap CMAP. If an
1759 exact match can't be allocated, try the nearest color available.
1760 Value is non-zero if successful. Set *COLOR to the color
1761 allocated. */
1762
1763 int
1764 x_alloc_nearest_color (struct frame *f, Colormap cmap, XColor *color)
1765 {
1766 gamma_correct (f, color);
1767 return x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), cmap, color);
1768 }
1769
1770
1771 /* Allocate color PIXEL on frame F. PIXEL must already be allocated.
1772 It's necessary to do this instead of just using PIXEL directly to
1773 get color reference counts right. */
1774
1775 unsigned long
1776 x_copy_color (struct frame *f, long unsigned int pixel)
1777 {
1778 XColor color;
1779
1780 color.pixel = pixel;
1781 BLOCK_INPUT;
1782 x_query_color (f, &color);
1783 XAllocColor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f), &color);
1784 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
1785 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1786 register_color (pixel);
1787 #endif
1788 return color.pixel;
1789 }
1790
1791
1792 /* Brightness beyond which a color won't have its highlight brightness
1793 boosted.
1794
1795 Nominally, highlight colors for `3d' faces are calculated by
1796 brightening an object's color by a constant scale factor, but this
1797 doesn't yield good results for dark colors, so for colors who's
1798 brightness is less than this value (on a scale of 0-65535) have an
1799 use an additional additive factor.
1800
1801 The value here is set so that the default menu-bar/mode-line color
1802 (grey75) will not have its highlights changed at all. */
1803 #define HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT 48000
1804
1805
1806 /* Allocate a color which is lighter or darker than *PIXEL by FACTOR
1807 or DELTA. Try a color with RGB values multiplied by FACTOR first.
1808 If this produces the same color as PIXEL, try a color where all RGB
1809 values have DELTA added. Return the allocated color in *PIXEL.
1810 DISPLAY is the X display, CMAP is the colormap to operate on.
1811 Value is non-zero if successful. */
1812
1813 static int
1814 x_alloc_lighter_color (struct frame *f, Display *display, Colormap cmap, long unsigned int *pixel, double factor, int delta)
1815 {
1816 XColor color, new;
1817 long bright;
1818 int success_p;
1819
1820 /* Get RGB color values. */
1821 color.pixel = *pixel;
1822 x_query_color (f, &color);
1823
1824 /* Change RGB values by specified FACTOR. Avoid overflow! */
1825 xassert (factor >= 0);
1826 new.red = min (0xffff, factor * color.red);
1827 new.green = min (0xffff, factor * color.green);
1828 new.blue = min (0xffff, factor * color.blue);
1829
1830 /* Calculate brightness of COLOR. */
1831 bright = (2 * color.red + 3 * color.green + color.blue) / 6;
1832
1833 /* We only boost colors that are darker than
1834 HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT. */
1835 if (bright < HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT)
1836 /* Make an additive adjustment to NEW, because it's dark enough so
1837 that scaling by FACTOR alone isn't enough. */
1838 {
1839 /* How far below the limit this color is (0 - 1, 1 being darker). */
1840 double dimness = 1 - (double)bright / HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT;
1841 /* The additive adjustment. */
1842 int min_delta = delta * dimness * factor / 2;
1843
1844 if (factor < 1)
1845 {
1846 new.red = max (0, new.red - min_delta);
1847 new.green = max (0, new.green - min_delta);
1848 new.blue = max (0, new.blue - min_delta);
1849 }
1850 else
1851 {
1852 new.red = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.red);
1853 new.green = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.green);
1854 new.blue = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.blue);
1855 }
1856 }
1857
1858 /* Try to allocate the color. */
1859 success_p = x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, &new);
1860 if (success_p)
1861 {
1862 if (new.pixel == *pixel)
1863 {
1864 /* If we end up with the same color as before, try adding
1865 delta to the RGB values. */
1866 x_free_colors (f, &new.pixel, 1);
1867
1868 new.red = min (0xffff, delta + color.red);
1869 new.green = min (0xffff, delta + color.green);
1870 new.blue = min (0xffff, delta + color.blue);
1871 success_p = x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, &new);
1872 }
1873 else
1874 success_p = 1;
1875 *pixel = new.pixel;
1876 }
1877
1878 return success_p;
1879 }
1880
1881
1882 /* Set up the foreground color for drawing relief lines of glyph
1883 string S. RELIEF is a pointer to a struct relief containing the GC
1884 with which lines will be drawn. Use a color that is FACTOR or
1885 DELTA lighter or darker than the relief's background which is found
1886 in S->f->output_data.x->relief_background. If such a color cannot
1887 be allocated, use DEFAULT_PIXEL, instead. */
1888
1889 static void
1890 x_setup_relief_color (struct frame *f, struct relief *relief, double factor, int delta, long unsigned int default_pixel)
1891 {
1892 XGCValues xgcv;
1893 struct x_output *di = f->output_data.x;
1894 unsigned long mask = GCForeground | GCLineWidth | GCGraphicsExposures;
1895 unsigned long pixel;
1896 unsigned long background = di->relief_background;
1897 Colormap cmap = FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f);
1898 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
1899 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
1900
1901 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
1902 xgcv.line_width = 1;
1903
1904 /* Free previously allocated color. The color cell will be reused
1905 when it has been freed as many times as it was allocated, so this
1906 doesn't affect faces using the same colors. */
1907 if (relief->gc
1908 && relief->allocated_p)
1909 {
1910 x_free_colors (f, &relief->pixel, 1);
1911 relief->allocated_p = 0;
1912 }
1913
1914 /* Allocate new color. */
1915 xgcv.foreground = default_pixel;
1916 pixel = background;
1917 if (dpyinfo->n_planes != 1
1918 && x_alloc_lighter_color (f, dpy, cmap, &pixel, factor, delta))
1919 {
1920 relief->allocated_p = 1;
1921 xgcv.foreground = relief->pixel = pixel;
1922 }
1923
1924 if (relief->gc == 0)
1925 {
1926 xgcv.stipple = dpyinfo->gray;
1927 mask |= GCStipple;
1928 relief->gc = XCreateGC (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), mask, &xgcv);
1929 }
1930 else
1931 XChangeGC (dpy, relief->gc, mask, &xgcv);
1932 }
1933
1934
1935 /* Set up colors for the relief lines around glyph string S. */
1936
1937 static void
1938 x_setup_relief_colors (struct glyph_string *s)
1939 {
1940 struct x_output *di = s->f->output_data.x;
1941 unsigned long color;
1942
1943 if (s->face->use_box_color_for_shadows_p)
1944 color = s->face->box_color;
1945 else if (s->first_glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH
1946 && s->img->pixmap
1947 && !IMAGE_BACKGROUND_TRANSPARENT (s->img, s->f, 0))
1948 color = IMAGE_BACKGROUND (s->img, s->f, 0);
1949 else
1950 {
1951 XGCValues xgcv;
1952
1953 /* Get the background color of the face. */
1954 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCBackground, &xgcv);
1955 color = xgcv.background;
1956 }
1957
1958 if (di->white_relief.gc == 0
1959 || color != di->relief_background)
1960 {
1961 di->relief_background = color;
1962 x_setup_relief_color (s->f, &di->white_relief, 1.2, 0x8000,
1963 WHITE_PIX_DEFAULT (s->f));
1964 x_setup_relief_color (s->f, &di->black_relief, 0.6, 0x4000,
1965 BLACK_PIX_DEFAULT (s->f));
1966 }
1967 }
1968
1969
1970 /* Draw a relief on frame F inside the rectangle given by LEFT_X,
1971 TOP_Y, RIGHT_X, and BOTTOM_Y. WIDTH is the thickness of the relief
1972 to draw, it must be >= 0. RAISED_P non-zero means draw a raised
1973 relief. LEFT_P non-zero means draw a relief on the left side of
1974 the rectangle. RIGHT_P non-zero means draw a relief on the right
1975 side of the rectangle. CLIP_RECT is the clipping rectangle to use
1976 when drawing. */
1977
1978 static void
1979 x_draw_relief_rect (struct frame *f,
1980 int left_x, int top_y, int right_x, int bottom_y, int width,
1981 int raised_p, int top_p, int bot_p, int left_p, int right_p,
1982 XRectangle *clip_rect)
1983 {
1984 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
1985 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
1986 int i;
1987 GC gc;
1988
1989 if (raised_p)
1990 gc = f->output_data.x->white_relief.gc;
1991 else
1992 gc = f->output_data.x->black_relief.gc;
1993 XSetClipRectangles (dpy, gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
1994
1995 /* This code is more complicated than it has to be, because of two
1996 minor hacks to make the boxes look nicer: (i) if width > 1, draw
1997 the outermost line using the black relief. (ii) Omit the four
1998 corner pixels. */
1999
2000 /* Top. */
2001 if (top_p)
2002 {
2003 if (width == 1)
2004 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2005 left_x + (left_p ? 1 : 0), top_y,
2006 right_x + (right_p ? 0 : 1), top_y);
2007
2008 for (i = 1; i < width; ++i)
2009 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2010 left_x + i * left_p, top_y + i,
2011 right_x + 1 - i * right_p, top_y + i);
2012 }
2013
2014 /* Left. */
2015 if (left_p)
2016 {
2017 if (width == 1)
2018 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc, left_x, top_y + 1, left_x, bottom_y);
2019
2020 XClearArea (dpy, window, left_x, top_y, 1, 1, False);
2021 XClearArea (dpy, window, left_x, bottom_y, 1, 1, False);
2022
2023 for (i = (width > 1 ? 1 : 0); i < width; ++i)
2024 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2025 left_x + i, top_y + i, left_x + i, bottom_y - i + 1);
2026 }
2027
2028 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
2029 if (raised_p)
2030 gc = f->output_data.x->black_relief.gc;
2031 else
2032 gc = f->output_data.x->white_relief.gc;
2033 XSetClipRectangles (dpy, gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2034
2035 if (width > 1)
2036 {
2037 /* Outermost top line. */
2038 if (top_p)
2039 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2040 left_x + (left_p ? 1 : 0), top_y,
2041 right_x + (right_p ? 0 : 1), top_y);
2042
2043 /* Outermost left line. */
2044 if (left_p)
2045 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc, left_x, top_y + 1, left_x, bottom_y);
2046 }
2047
2048 /* Bottom. */
2049 if (bot_p)
2050 {
2051 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2052 left_x + (left_p ? 1 : 0), bottom_y,
2053 right_x + (right_p ? 0 : 1), bottom_y);
2054 for (i = 1; i < width; ++i)
2055 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2056 left_x + i * left_p, bottom_y - i,
2057 right_x + 1 - i * right_p, bottom_y - i);
2058 }
2059
2060 /* Right. */
2061 if (right_p)
2062 {
2063 XClearArea (dpy, window, right_x, top_y, 1, 1, False);
2064 XClearArea (dpy, window, right_x, bottom_y, 1, 1, False);
2065 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
2066 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2067 right_x - i, top_y + i + 1, right_x - i, bottom_y - i);
2068 }
2069
2070 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
2071 }
2072
2073
2074 /* Draw a box on frame F inside the rectangle given by LEFT_X, TOP_Y,
2075 RIGHT_X, and BOTTOM_Y. WIDTH is the thickness of the lines to
2076 draw, it must be >= 0. LEFT_P non-zero means draw a line on the
2077 left side of the rectangle. RIGHT_P non-zero means draw a line
2078 on the right side of the rectangle. CLIP_RECT is the clipping
2079 rectangle to use when drawing. */
2080
2081 static void
2082 x_draw_box_rect (struct glyph_string *s,
2083 int left_x, int top_y, int right_x, int bottom_y, int width,
2084 int left_p, int right_p, XRectangle *clip_rect)
2085 {
2086 XGCValues xgcv;
2087
2088 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2089 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->box_color);
2090 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2091
2092 /* Top. */
2093 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2094 left_x, top_y, right_x - left_x + 1, width);
2095
2096 /* Left. */
2097 if (left_p)
2098 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2099 left_x, top_y, width, bottom_y - top_y + 1);
2100
2101 /* Bottom. */
2102 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2103 left_x, bottom_y - width + 1, right_x - left_x + 1, width);
2104
2105 /* Right. */
2106 if (right_p)
2107 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2108 right_x - width + 1, top_y, width, bottom_y - top_y + 1);
2109
2110 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2111 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2112 }
2113
2114
2115 /* Draw a box around glyph string S. */
2116
2117 static void
2118 x_draw_glyph_string_box (struct glyph_string *s)
2119 {
2120 int width, left_x, right_x, top_y, bottom_y, last_x, raised_p;
2121 int left_p, right_p;
2122 struct glyph *last_glyph;
2123 XRectangle clip_rect;
2124
2125 last_x = ((s->row->full_width_p && !s->w->pseudo_window_p)
2126 ? WINDOW_RIGHT_EDGE_X (s->w)
2127 : window_box_right (s->w, s->area));
2128
2129 /* The glyph that may have a right box line. */
2130 last_glyph = (s->cmp || s->img
2131 ? s->first_glyph
2132 : s->first_glyph + s->nchars - 1);
2133
2134 width = eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2135 raised_p = s->face->box == FACE_RAISED_BOX;
2136 left_x = s->x;
2137 right_x = (s->row->full_width_p && s->extends_to_end_of_line_p
2138 ? last_x - 1
2139 : min (last_x, s->x + s->background_width) - 1);
2140 top_y = s->y;
2141 bottom_y = top_y + s->height - 1;
2142
2143 left_p = (s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2144 || (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
2145 && (s->prev == NULL
2146 || s->prev->hl != s->hl)));
2147 right_p = (last_glyph->right_box_line_p
2148 || (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
2149 && (s->next == NULL
2150 || s->next->hl != s->hl)));
2151
2152 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2153
2154 if (s->face->box == FACE_SIMPLE_BOX)
2155 x_draw_box_rect (s, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width,
2156 left_p, right_p, &clip_rect);
2157 else
2158 {
2159 x_setup_relief_colors (s);
2160 x_draw_relief_rect (s->f, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y,
2161 width, raised_p, 1, 1, left_p, right_p, &clip_rect);
2162 }
2163 }
2164
2165
2166 /* Draw foreground of image glyph string S. */
2167
2168 static void
2169 x_draw_image_foreground (struct glyph_string *s)
2170 {
2171 int x = s->x;
2172 int y = s->ybase - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2173
2174 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2175 right of that line. */
2176 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2177 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2178 && s->slice.x == 0)
2179 x += eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2180
2181 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2182 by that margin. */
2183 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2184 x += s->img->hmargin;
2185 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2186 y += s->img->vmargin;
2187
2188 if (s->img->pixmap)
2189 {
2190 if (s->img->mask)
2191 {
2192 /* We can't set both a clip mask and use XSetClipRectangles
2193 because the latter also sets a clip mask. We also can't
2194 trust on the shape extension to be available
2195 (XShapeCombineRegion). So, compute the rectangle to draw
2196 manually. */
2197 unsigned long mask = (GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin
2198 | GCFunction);
2199 XGCValues xgcv;
2200 XRectangle clip_rect, image_rect, r;
2201
2202 xgcv.clip_mask = s->img->mask;
2203 xgcv.clip_x_origin = x;
2204 xgcv.clip_y_origin = y;
2205 xgcv.function = GXcopy;
2206 XChangeGC (s->display, s->gc, mask, &xgcv);
2207
2208 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2209 image_rect.x = x;
2210 image_rect.y = y;
2211 image_rect.width = s->slice.width;
2212 image_rect.height = s->slice.height;
2213 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&clip_rect, &image_rect, &r))
2214 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2215 s->slice.x + r.x - x, s->slice.y + r.y - y,
2216 r.width, r.height, r.x, r.y);
2217 }
2218 else
2219 {
2220 XRectangle clip_rect, image_rect, r;
2221
2222 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2223 image_rect.x = x;
2224 image_rect.y = y;
2225 image_rect.width = s->slice.width;
2226 image_rect.height = s->slice.height;
2227 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&clip_rect, &image_rect, &r))
2228 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2229 s->slice.x + r.x - x, s->slice.y + r.y - y,
2230 r.width, r.height, r.x, r.y);
2231
2232 /* When the image has a mask, we can expect that at
2233 least part of a mouse highlight or a block cursor will
2234 be visible. If the image doesn't have a mask, make
2235 a block cursor visible by drawing a rectangle around
2236 the image. I believe it's looking better if we do
2237 nothing here for mouse-face. */
2238 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
2239 {
2240 int relief = s->img->relief;
2241 if (relief < 0) relief = -relief;
2242 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2243 x - relief, y - relief,
2244 s->slice.width + relief*2 - 1,
2245 s->slice.height + relief*2 - 1);
2246 }
2247 }
2248 }
2249 else
2250 /* Draw a rectangle if image could not be loaded. */
2251 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y,
2252 s->slice.width - 1, s->slice.height - 1);
2253 }
2254
2255
2256 /* Draw a relief around the image glyph string S. */
2257
2258 static void
2259 x_draw_image_relief (struct glyph_string *s)
2260 {
2261 int x0, y0, x1, y1, thick, raised_p, extra;
2262 XRectangle r;
2263 int x = s->x;
2264 int y = s->ybase - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2265
2266 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2267 right of that line. */
2268 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2269 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2270 && s->slice.x == 0)
2271 x += eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2272
2273 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2274 by that margin. */
2275 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2276 x += s->img->hmargin;
2277 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2278 y += s->img->vmargin;
2279
2280 if (s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN
2281 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED)
2282 {
2283 thick = tool_bar_button_relief >= 0 ? tool_bar_button_relief : DEFAULT_TOOL_BAR_BUTTON_RELIEF;
2284 raised_p = s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED;
2285 }
2286 else
2287 {
2288 thick = eabs (s->img->relief);
2289 raised_p = s->img->relief > 0;
2290 }
2291
2292 extra = s->face->id == TOOL_BAR_FACE_ID
2293 ? XINT (Vtool_bar_button_margin) : 0;
2294
2295 x0 = x - thick - extra;
2296 y0 = y - thick - extra;
2297 x1 = x + s->slice.width + thick - 1 + extra;
2298 y1 = y + s->slice.height + thick - 1 + extra;
2299
2300 x_setup_relief_colors (s);
2301 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
2302 x_draw_relief_rect (s->f, x0, y0, x1, y1, thick, raised_p,
2303 s->slice.y == 0,
2304 s->slice.y + s->slice.height == s->img->height,
2305 s->slice.x == 0,
2306 s->slice.x + s->slice.width == s->img->width,
2307 &r);
2308 }
2309
2310
2311 /* Draw the foreground of image glyph string S to PIXMAP. */
2312
2313 static void
2314 x_draw_image_foreground_1 (struct glyph_string *s, Pixmap pixmap)
2315 {
2316 int x = 0;
2317 int y = s->ybase - s->y - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2318
2319 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2320 right of that line. */
2321 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2322 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2323 && s->slice.x == 0)
2324 x += eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2325
2326 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2327 by that margin. */
2328 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2329 x += s->img->hmargin;
2330 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2331 y += s->img->vmargin;
2332
2333 if (s->img->pixmap)
2334 {
2335 if (s->img->mask)
2336 {
2337 /* We can't set both a clip mask and use XSetClipRectangles
2338 because the latter also sets a clip mask. We also can't
2339 trust on the shape extension to be available
2340 (XShapeCombineRegion). So, compute the rectangle to draw
2341 manually. */
2342 unsigned long mask = (GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin
2343 | GCFunction);
2344 XGCValues xgcv;
2345
2346 xgcv.clip_mask = s->img->mask;
2347 xgcv.clip_x_origin = x - s->slice.x;
2348 xgcv.clip_y_origin = y - s->slice.y;
2349 xgcv.function = GXcopy;
2350 XChangeGC (s->display, s->gc, mask, &xgcv);
2351
2352 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, pixmap, s->gc,
2353 s->slice.x, s->slice.y,
2354 s->slice.width, s->slice.height, x, y);
2355 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2356 }
2357 else
2358 {
2359 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, pixmap, s->gc,
2360 s->slice.x, s->slice.y,
2361 s->slice.width, s->slice.height, x, y);
2362
2363 /* When the image has a mask, we can expect that at
2364 least part of a mouse highlight or a block cursor will
2365 be visible. If the image doesn't have a mask, make
2366 a block cursor visible by drawing a rectangle around
2367 the image. I believe it's looking better if we do
2368 nothing here for mouse-face. */
2369 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
2370 {
2371 int r = s->img->relief;
2372 if (r < 0) r = -r;
2373 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x - r, y - r,
2374 s->slice.width + r*2 - 1,
2375 s->slice.height + r*2 - 1);
2376 }
2377 }
2378 }
2379 else
2380 /* Draw a rectangle if image could not be loaded. */
2381 XDrawRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc, x, y,
2382 s->slice.width - 1, s->slice.height - 1);
2383 }
2384
2385
2386 /* Draw part of the background of glyph string S. X, Y, W, and H
2387 give the rectangle to draw. */
2388
2389 static void
2390 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (struct glyph_string *s, int x, int y, int w, int h)
2391 {
2392 if (s->stippled_p)
2393 {
2394 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2395 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2396 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y, w, h);
2397 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
2398 }
2399 else
2400 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, x, y, w, h);
2401 }
2402
2403
2404 /* Draw image glyph string S.
2405
2406 s->y
2407 s->x +-------------------------
2408 | s->face->box
2409 |
2410 | +-------------------------
2411 | | s->img->margin
2412 | |
2413 | | +-------------------
2414 | | | the image
2415
2416 */
2417
2418 static void
2419 x_draw_image_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s)
2420 {
2421 int box_line_hwidth = eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2422 int box_line_vwidth = max (s->face->box_line_width, 0);
2423 int height;
2424 Pixmap pixmap = None;
2425
2426 height = s->height;
2427 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2428 height -= box_line_vwidth;
2429 if (s->slice.y + s->slice.height >= s->img->height)
2430 height -= box_line_vwidth;
2431
2432 /* Fill background with face under the image. Do it only if row is
2433 taller than image or if image has a clip mask to reduce
2434 flickering. */
2435 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
2436 if (height > s->slice.height
2437 || s->img->hmargin
2438 || s->img->vmargin
2439 || s->img->mask
2440 || s->img->pixmap == 0
2441 || s->width != s->background_width)
2442 {
2443 if (s->img->mask)
2444 {
2445 /* Create a pixmap as large as the glyph string. Fill it
2446 with the background color. Copy the image to it, using
2447 its mask. Copy the temporary pixmap to the display. */
2448 Screen *screen = FRAME_X_SCREEN (s->f);
2449 int depth = DefaultDepthOfScreen (screen);
2450
2451 /* Create a pixmap as large as the glyph string. */
2452 pixmap = XCreatePixmap (s->display, s->window,
2453 s->background_width,
2454 s->height, depth);
2455
2456 /* Don't clip in the following because we're working on the
2457 pixmap. */
2458 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2459
2460 /* Fill the pixmap with the background color/stipple. */
2461 if (s->stippled_p)
2462 {
2463 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2464 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2465 XSetTSOrigin (s->display, s->gc, - s->x, - s->y);
2466 XFillRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc,
2467 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height);
2468 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
2469 XSetTSOrigin (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0);
2470 }
2471 else
2472 {
2473 XGCValues xgcv;
2474 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground | GCBackground,
2475 &xgcv);
2476 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.background);
2477 XFillRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc,
2478 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height);
2479 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2480 }
2481 }
2482 else
2483 {
2484 int x = s->x;
2485 int y = s->y;
2486
2487 if (s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2488 && s->slice.x == 0)
2489 x += box_line_hwidth;
2490
2491 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2492 y += box_line_vwidth;
2493
2494 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, y, s->background_width, height);
2495 }
2496
2497 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2498 }
2499
2500 /* Draw the foreground. */
2501 if (pixmap != None)
2502 {
2503 x_draw_image_foreground_1 (s, pixmap);
2504 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2505 XCopyArea (s->display, pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2506 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height, s->x, s->y);
2507 XFreePixmap (s->display, pixmap);
2508 }
2509 else
2510 x_draw_image_foreground (s);
2511
2512 /* If we must draw a relief around the image, do it. */
2513 if (s->img->relief
2514 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
2515 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN)
2516 x_draw_image_relief (s);
2517 }
2518
2519
2520 /* Draw stretch glyph string S. */
2521
2522 static void
2523 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s)
2524 {
2525 xassert (s->first_glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH);
2526
2527 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR
2528 && !x_stretch_cursor_p)
2529 {
2530 /* If `x-stretch-cursor' is nil, don't draw a block cursor as
2531 wide as the stretch glyph. */
2532 int width, background_width = s->background_width;
2533 int x = s->x;
2534
2535 if (!s->row->reversed_p)
2536 {
2537 int left_x = window_box_left_offset (s->w, TEXT_AREA);
2538
2539 if (x < left_x)
2540 {
2541 background_width -= left_x - x;
2542 x = left_x;
2543 }
2544 }
2545 else
2546 {
2547 /* In R2L rows, draw the cursor on the right edge of the
2548 stretch glyph. */
2549 int right_x = window_box_right_offset (s->w, TEXT_AREA);
2550
2551 if (x + background_width > right_x)
2552 background_width -= x - right_x;
2553 x += background_width;
2554 }
2555 width = min (FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (s->f), background_width);
2556 if (s->row->reversed_p)
2557 x -= width;
2558
2559 /* Draw cursor. */
2560 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, s->y, width, s->height);
2561
2562 /* Clear rest using the GC of the original non-cursor face. */
2563 if (width < background_width)
2564 {
2565 int y = s->y;
2566 int w = background_width - width, h = s->height;
2567 XRectangle r;
2568 GC gc;
2569
2570 if (!s->row->reversed_p)
2571 x += width;
2572 else
2573 x = s->x;
2574 if (s->row->mouse_face_p
2575 && cursor_in_mouse_face_p (s->w))
2576 {
2577 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s);
2578 gc = s->gc;
2579 }
2580 else
2581 gc = s->face->gc;
2582
2583 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
2584 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, gc, 0, 0, &r, 1, Unsorted);
2585
2586 if (s->face->stipple)
2587 {
2588 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2589 XSetFillStyle (s->display, gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2590 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, gc, x, y, w, h);
2591 XSetFillStyle (s->display, gc, FillSolid);
2592 }
2593 else
2594 {
2595 XGCValues xgcv;
2596 XGetGCValues (s->display, gc, GCForeground | GCBackground, &xgcv);
2597 XSetForeground (s->display, gc, xgcv.background);
2598 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, gc, x, y, w, h);
2599 XSetForeground (s->display, gc, xgcv.foreground);
2600 }
2601 }
2602 }
2603 else if (!s->background_filled_p)
2604 {
2605 int background_width = s->background_width;
2606 int x = s->x, left_x = window_box_left_offset (s->w, TEXT_AREA);
2607
2608 /* Don't draw into left margin, fringe or scrollbar area
2609 except for header line and mode line. */
2610 if (x < left_x && !s->row->mode_line_p)
2611 {
2612 background_width -= left_x - x;
2613 x = left_x;
2614 }
2615 if (background_width > 0)
2616 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, s->y, background_width, s->height);
2617 }
2618
2619 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2620 }
2621
2622
2623 /* Draw glyph string S. */
2624
2625 static void
2626 x_draw_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s)
2627 {
2628 int relief_drawn_p = 0;
2629
2630 /* If S draws into the background of its successors, draw the
2631 background of the successors first so that S can draw into it.
2632 This makes S->next use XDrawString instead of XDrawImageString. */
2633 if (s->next && s->right_overhang && !s->for_overlaps)
2634 {
2635 int width;
2636 struct glyph_string *next;
2637
2638 for (width = 0, next = s->next;
2639 next && width < s->right_overhang;
2640 width += next->width, next = next->next)
2641 if (next->first_glyph->type != IMAGE_GLYPH)
2642 {
2643 x_set_glyph_string_gc (next);
2644 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (next);
2645 if (next->first_glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH)
2646 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (next);
2647 else
2648 x_draw_glyph_string_background (next, 1);
2649 next->num_clips = 0;
2650 }
2651 }
2652
2653 /* Set up S->gc, set clipping and draw S. */
2654 x_set_glyph_string_gc (s);
2655
2656 /* Draw relief (if any) in advance for char/composition so that the
2657 glyph string can be drawn over it. */
2658 if (!s->for_overlaps
2659 && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2660 && (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
2661 || s->first_glyph->type == COMPOSITE_GLYPH))
2662
2663 {
2664 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2665 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2666 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s);
2667 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2668 relief_drawn_p = 1;
2669 }
2670 else if (!s->clip_head /* draw_glyphs didn't specify a clip mask. */
2671 && !s->clip_tail
2672 && ((s->prev && s->prev->hl != s->hl && s->left_overhang)
2673 || (s->next && s->next->hl != s->hl && s->right_overhang)))
2674 /* We must clip just this glyph. left_overhang part has already
2675 drawn when s->prev was drawn, and right_overhang part will be
2676 drawn later when s->next is drawn. */
2677 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (s, s);
2678 else
2679 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2680
2681 switch (s->first_glyph->type)
2682 {
2683 case IMAGE_GLYPH:
2684 x_draw_image_glyph_string (s);
2685 break;
2686
2687 case STRETCH_GLYPH:
2688 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (s);
2689 break;
2690
2691 case CHAR_GLYPH:
2692 if (s->for_overlaps)
2693 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2694 else
2695 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 0);
2696 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2697 break;
2698
2699 case COMPOSITE_GLYPH:
2700 if (s->for_overlaps || (s->cmp_from > 0
2701 && ! s->first_glyph->u.cmp.automatic))
2702 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2703 else
2704 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2705 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2706 break;
2707
2708 case GLYPHLESS_GLYPH:
2709 if (s->for_overlaps)
2710 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2711 else
2712 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2713 x_draw_glyphless_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2714 break;
2715
2716 default:
2717 abort ();
2718 }
2719
2720 if (!s->for_overlaps)
2721 {
2722 /* Draw underline. */
2723 if (s->face->underline_p)
2724 {
2725 unsigned long thickness, position;
2726 int y;
2727
2728 if (s->prev && s->prev->face->underline_p)
2729 {
2730 /* We use the same underline style as the previous one. */
2731 thickness = s->prev->underline_thickness;
2732 position = s->prev->underline_position;
2733 }
2734 else
2735 {
2736 /* Get the underline thickness. Default is 1 pixel. */
2737 if (s->font && s->font->underline_thickness > 0)
2738 thickness = s->font->underline_thickness;
2739 else
2740 thickness = 1;
2741 if (x_underline_at_descent_line)
2742 position = (s->height - thickness) - (s->ybase - s->y);
2743 else
2744 {
2745 /* Get the underline position. This is the recommended
2746 vertical offset in pixels from the baseline to the top of
2747 the underline. This is a signed value according to the
2748 specs, and its default is
2749
2750 ROUND ((maximum descent) / 2), with
2751 ROUND(x) = floor (x + 0.5) */
2752
2753 if (x_use_underline_position_properties
2754 && s->font && s->font->underline_position >= 0)
2755 position = s->font->underline_position;
2756 else if (s->font)
2757 position = (s->font->descent + 1) / 2;
2758 else
2759 position = underline_minimum_offset;
2760 }
2761 position = max (position, underline_minimum_offset);
2762 }
2763 /* Check the sanity of thickness and position. We should
2764 avoid drawing underline out of the current line area. */
2765 if (s->y + s->height <= s->ybase + position)
2766 position = (s->height - 1) - (s->ybase - s->y);
2767 if (s->y + s->height < s->ybase + position + thickness)
2768 thickness = (s->y + s->height) - (s->ybase + position);
2769 s->underline_thickness = thickness;
2770 s->underline_position = position;
2771 y = s->ybase + position;
2772 if (s->face->underline_defaulted_p)
2773 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2774 s->x, y, s->width, thickness);
2775 else
2776 {
2777 XGCValues xgcv;
2778 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2779 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->underline_color);
2780 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2781 s->x, y, s->width, thickness);
2782 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2783 }
2784 }
2785
2786 /* Draw overline. */
2787 if (s->face->overline_p)
2788 {
2789 unsigned long dy = 0, h = 1;
2790
2791 if (s->face->overline_color_defaulted_p)
2792 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2793 s->width, h);
2794 else
2795 {
2796 XGCValues xgcv;
2797 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2798 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->overline_color);
2799 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2800 s->width, h);
2801 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2802 }
2803 }
2804
2805 /* Draw strike-through. */
2806 if (s->face->strike_through_p)
2807 {
2808 unsigned long h = 1;
2809 unsigned long dy = (s->height - h) / 2;
2810
2811 if (s->face->strike_through_color_defaulted_p)
2812 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2813 s->width, h);
2814 else
2815 {
2816 XGCValues xgcv;
2817 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2818 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->strike_through_color);
2819 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2820 s->width, h);
2821 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2822 }
2823 }
2824
2825 /* Draw relief if not yet drawn. */
2826 if (!relief_drawn_p && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX)
2827 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s);
2828
2829 if (s->prev)
2830 {
2831 struct glyph_string *prev;
2832
2833 for (prev = s->prev; prev; prev = prev->prev)
2834 if (prev->hl != s->hl
2835 && prev->x + prev->width + prev->right_overhang > s->x)
2836 {
2837 /* As prev was drawn while clipped to its own area, we
2838 must draw the right_overhang part using s->hl now. */
2839 enum draw_glyphs_face save = prev->hl;
2840
2841 prev->hl = s->hl;
2842 x_set_glyph_string_gc (prev);
2843 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (s, prev);
2844 if (prev->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
2845 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (prev);
2846 else
2847 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (prev);
2848 XSetClipMask (prev->display, prev->gc, None);
2849 prev->hl = save;
2850 prev->num_clips = 0;
2851 }
2852 }
2853
2854 if (s->next)
2855 {
2856 struct glyph_string *next;
2857
2858 for (next = s->next; next; next = next->next)
2859 if (next->hl != s->hl
2860 && next->x - next->left_overhang < s->x + s->width)
2861 {
2862 /* As next will be drawn while clipped to its own area,
2863 we must draw the left_overhang part using s->hl now. */
2864 enum draw_glyphs_face save = next->hl;
2865
2866 next->hl = s->hl;
2867 x_set_glyph_string_gc (next);
2868 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (s, next);
2869 if (next->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
2870 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (next);
2871 else
2872 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (next);
2873 XSetClipMask (next->display, next->gc, None);
2874 next->hl = save;
2875 next->num_clips = 0;
2876 }
2877 }
2878 }
2879
2880 /* Reset clipping. */
2881 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2882 s->num_clips = 0;
2883 }
2884
2885 /* Shift display to make room for inserted glyphs. */
2886
2887 static void
2888 x_shift_glyphs_for_insert (struct frame *f, int x, int y, int width, int height, int shift_by)
2889 {
2890 XCopyArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
2891 f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
2892 x, y, width, height,
2893 x + shift_by, y);
2894 }
2895
2896 /* Delete N glyphs at the nominal cursor position. Not implemented
2897 for X frames. */
2898
2899 static void
2900 x_delete_glyphs (struct frame *f, register int n)
2901 {
2902 abort ();
2903 }
2904
2905
2906 /* Like XClearArea, but check that WIDTH and HEIGHT are reasonable.
2907 If they are <= 0, this is probably an error. */
2908
2909 void
2910 x_clear_area (Display *dpy, Window window, int x, int y, int width, int height, int exposures)
2911 {
2912 xassert (width > 0 && height > 0);
2913 XClearArea (dpy, window, x, y, width, height, exposures);
2914 }
2915
2916
2917 /* Clear an entire frame. */
2918
2919 static void
2920 x_clear_frame (struct frame *f)
2921 {
2922 /* Clearing the frame will erase any cursor, so mark them all as no
2923 longer visible. */
2924 mark_window_cursors_off (XWINDOW (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f)));
2925 output_cursor.hpos = output_cursor.vpos = 0;
2926 output_cursor.x = -1;
2927
2928 /* We don't set the output cursor here because there will always
2929 follow an explicit cursor_to. */
2930 BLOCK_INPUT;
2931 XClearWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
2932
2933 /* We have to clear the scroll bars, too. If we have changed
2934 colors or something like that, then they should be notified. */
2935 x_scroll_bar_clear (f);
2936
2937 #if defined (USE_GTK) && defined (USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS)
2938 /* Make sure scroll bars are redrawn. As they aren't redrawn by
2939 redisplay, do it here. */
2940 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f))
2941 gtk_widget_queue_draw (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f));
2942 #endif
2943
2944 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
2945
2946 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
2947 }
2948
2949
2950 \f
2951 /* Invert the middle quarter of the frame for .15 sec. */
2952
2953 /* We use the select system call to do the waiting, so we have to make
2954 sure it's available. If it isn't, we just won't do visual bells. */
2955
2956 #if defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT)
2957
2958
2959 /* Subtract the `struct timeval' values X and Y, storing the result in
2960 *RESULT. Return 1 if the difference is negative, otherwise 0. */
2961
2962 static int
2963 timeval_subtract (struct timeval *result, struct timeval x, struct timeval y)
2964 {
2965 /* Perform the carry for the later subtraction by updating y. This
2966 is safer because on some systems the tv_sec member is unsigned. */
2967 if (x.tv_usec < y.tv_usec)
2968 {
2969 int nsec = (y.tv_usec - x.tv_usec) / 1000000 + 1;
2970 y.tv_usec -= 1000000 * nsec;
2971 y.tv_sec += nsec;
2972 }
2973
2974 if (x.tv_usec - y.tv_usec > 1000000)
2975 {
2976 int nsec = (y.tv_usec - x.tv_usec) / 1000000;
2977 y.tv_usec += 1000000 * nsec;
2978 y.tv_sec -= nsec;
2979 }
2980
2981 /* Compute the time remaining to wait. tv_usec is certainly
2982 positive. */
2983 result->tv_sec = x.tv_sec - y.tv_sec;
2984 result->tv_usec = x.tv_usec - y.tv_usec;
2985
2986 /* Return indication of whether the result should be considered
2987 negative. */
2988 return x.tv_sec < y.tv_sec;
2989 }
2990
2991 static void
2992 XTflash (struct frame *f)
2993 {
2994 BLOCK_INPUT;
2995
2996 {
2997 #ifdef USE_GTK
2998 /* Use Gdk routines to draw. This way, we won't draw over scroll bars
2999 when the scroll bars and the edit widget share the same X window. */
3000 GdkWindow *window = gtk_widget_get_window (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f));
3001 #ifdef HAVE_GTK3
3002 cairo_t *cr = gdk_cairo_create (window);
3003 cairo_set_source_rgb (cr, 1, 1, 1);
3004 cairo_set_operator (cr, CAIRO_OPERATOR_DIFFERENCE);
3005 #define XFillRectangle(d, win, gc, x, y, w, h) \
3006 do { \
3007 cairo_rectangle (cr, x, y, w, h); \
3008 cairo_fill (cr); \
3009 } \
3010 while (0)
3011 #else /* ! HAVE_GTK3 */
3012 GdkGCValues vals;
3013 GdkGC *gc;
3014 vals.foreground.pixel = (FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f)
3015 ^ FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f));
3016 vals.function = GDK_XOR;
3017 gc = gdk_gc_new_with_values (window,
3018 &vals, GDK_GC_FUNCTION | GDK_GC_FOREGROUND);
3019 #define XFillRectangle(d, win, gc, x, y, w, h) \
3020 gdk_draw_rectangle (window, gc, TRUE, x, y, w, h)
3021 #endif /* ! HAVE_GTK3 */
3022 #else /* ! USE_GTK */
3023 GC gc;
3024
3025 /* Create a GC that will use the GXxor function to flip foreground
3026 pixels into background pixels. */
3027 {
3028 XGCValues values;
3029
3030 values.function = GXxor;
3031 values.foreground = (FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f)
3032 ^ FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f));
3033
3034 gc = XCreateGC (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3035 GCFunction | GCForeground, &values);
3036 }
3037 #endif
3038 {
3039 /* Get the height not including a menu bar widget. */
3040 int height = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, FRAME_LINES (f));
3041 /* Height of each line to flash. */
3042 int flash_height = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
3043 /* These will be the left and right margins of the rectangles. */
3044 int flash_left = FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
3045 int flash_right = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
3046
3047 int width;
3048
3049 /* Don't flash the area between a scroll bar and the frame
3050 edge it is next to. */
3051 switch (FRAME_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TYPE (f))
3052 {
3053 case vertical_scroll_bar_left:
3054 flash_left += VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
3055 break;
3056
3057 case vertical_scroll_bar_right:
3058 flash_right -= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
3059 break;
3060
3061 default:
3062 break;
3063 }
3064
3065 width = flash_right - flash_left;
3066
3067 /* If window is tall, flash top and bottom line. */
3068 if (height > 3 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f))
3069 {
3070 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3071 flash_left,
3072 (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)
3073 + FRAME_TOP_MARGIN_HEIGHT (f)),
3074 width, flash_height);
3075 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3076 flash_left,
3077 (height - flash_height
3078 - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)),
3079 width, flash_height);
3080
3081 }
3082 else
3083 /* If it is short, flash it all. */
3084 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3085 flash_left, FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
3086 width, height - 2 * FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f));
3087
3088 x_flush (f);
3089
3090 {
3091 struct timeval wakeup;
3092
3093 EMACS_GET_TIME (wakeup);
3094
3095 /* Compute time to wait until, propagating carry from usecs. */
3096 wakeup.tv_usec += 150000;
3097 wakeup.tv_sec += (wakeup.tv_usec / 1000000);
3098 wakeup.tv_usec %= 1000000;
3099
3100 /* Keep waiting until past the time wakeup or any input gets
3101 available. */
3102 while (! detect_input_pending ())
3103 {
3104 struct timeval current;
3105 struct timeval timeout;
3106
3107 EMACS_GET_TIME (current);
3108
3109 /* Break if result would be negative. */
3110 if (timeval_subtract (&current, wakeup, current))
3111 break;
3112
3113 /* How long `select' should wait. */
3114 timeout.tv_sec = 0;
3115 timeout.tv_usec = 10000;
3116
3117 /* Try to wait that long--but we might wake up sooner. */
3118 select (0, NULL, NULL, NULL, &timeout);
3119 }
3120 }
3121
3122 /* If window is tall, flash top and bottom line. */
3123 if (height > 3 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f))
3124 {
3125 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3126 flash_left,
3127 (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)
3128 + FRAME_TOP_MARGIN_HEIGHT (f)),
3129 width, flash_height);
3130 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3131 flash_left,
3132 (height - flash_height
3133 - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)),
3134 width, flash_height);
3135 }
3136 else
3137 /* If it is short, flash it all. */
3138 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3139 flash_left, FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
3140 width, height - 2 * FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f));
3141
3142 #ifdef USE_GTK
3143 #ifdef HAVE_GTK3
3144 cairo_destroy (cr);
3145 #else
3146 g_object_unref (G_OBJECT (gc));
3147 #endif
3148 #undef XFillRectangle
3149 #else
3150 XFreeGC (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc);
3151 #endif
3152 x_flush (f);
3153 }
3154 }
3155
3156 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3157 }
3158
3159 #endif /* defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT) */
3160
3161
3162 static void
3163 XTtoggle_invisible_pointer (FRAME_PTR f, int invisible)
3164 {
3165 BLOCK_INPUT;
3166 if (invisible)
3167 {
3168 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->invisible_cursor != 0)
3169 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3170 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->invisible_cursor);
3171 }
3172 else
3173 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3174 f->output_data.x->current_cursor);
3175 f->pointer_invisible = invisible;
3176 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3177 }
3178
3179
3180 /* Make audible bell. */
3181
3182 static void
3183 XTring_bell (struct frame *f)
3184 {
3185 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f))
3186 {
3187 #if defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT)
3188 if (visible_bell)
3189 XTflash (f);
3190 else
3191 #endif
3192 {
3193 BLOCK_INPUT;
3194 XBell (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), 0);
3195 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
3196 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3197 }
3198 }
3199 }
3200
3201 \f
3202 /* Specify how many text lines, from the top of the window,
3203 should be affected by insert-lines and delete-lines operations.
3204 This, and those operations, are used only within an update
3205 that is bounded by calls to x_update_begin and x_update_end. */
3206
3207 static void
3208 XTset_terminal_window (struct frame *f, int n)
3209 {
3210 /* This function intentionally left blank. */
3211 }
3212
3213
3214 \f
3215 /***********************************************************************
3216 Line Dance
3217 ***********************************************************************/
3218
3219 /* Perform an insert-lines or delete-lines operation, inserting N
3220 lines or deleting -N lines at vertical position VPOS. */
3221
3222 static void
3223 x_ins_del_lines (struct frame *f, int vpos, int n)
3224 {
3225 abort ();
3226 }
3227
3228
3229 /* Scroll part of the display as described by RUN. */
3230
3231 static void
3232 x_scroll_run (struct window *w, struct run *run)
3233 {
3234 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
3235 int x, y, width, height, from_y, to_y, bottom_y;
3236
3237 /* Get frame-relative bounding box of the text display area of W,
3238 without mode lines. Include in this box the left and right
3239 fringe of W. */
3240 window_box (w, -1, &x, &y, &width, &height);
3241
3242 from_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, run->current_y);
3243 to_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, run->desired_y);
3244 bottom_y = y + height;
3245
3246 if (to_y < from_y)
3247 {
3248 /* Scrolling up. Make sure we don't copy part of the mode
3249 line at the bottom. */
3250 if (from_y + run->height > bottom_y)
3251 height = bottom_y - from_y;
3252 else
3253 height = run->height;
3254 }
3255 else
3256 {
3257 /* Scolling down. Make sure we don't copy over the mode line.
3258 at the bottom. */
3259 if (to_y + run->height > bottom_y)
3260 height = bottom_y - to_y;
3261 else
3262 height = run->height;
3263 }
3264
3265 BLOCK_INPUT;
3266
3267 /* Cursor off. Will be switched on again in x_update_window_end. */
3268 updated_window = w;
3269 x_clear_cursor (w);
3270
3271 XCopyArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
3272 FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3273 f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
3274 x, from_y,
3275 width, height,
3276 x, to_y);
3277
3278 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3279 }
3280
3281
3282 \f
3283 /***********************************************************************
3284 Exposure Events
3285 ***********************************************************************/
3286
3287 \f
3288 static void
3289 frame_highlight (struct frame *f)
3290 {
3291 /* We used to only do this if Vx_no_window_manager was non-nil, but
3292 the ICCCM (section 4.1.6) says that the window's border pixmap
3293 and border pixel are window attributes which are "private to the
3294 client", so we can always change it to whatever we want. */
3295 BLOCK_INPUT;
3296 XSetWindowBorder (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3297 f->output_data.x->border_pixel);
3298 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3299 x_update_cursor (f, 1);
3300 x_set_frame_alpha (f);
3301 }
3302
3303 static void
3304 frame_unhighlight (struct frame *f)
3305 {
3306 /* We used to only do this if Vx_no_window_manager was non-nil, but
3307 the ICCCM (section 4.1.6) says that the window's border pixmap
3308 and border pixel are window attributes which are "private to the
3309 client", so we can always change it to whatever we want. */
3310 BLOCK_INPUT;
3311 XSetWindowBorderPixmap (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3312 f->output_data.x->border_tile);
3313 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3314 x_update_cursor (f, 1);
3315 x_set_frame_alpha (f);
3316 }
3317
3318 /* The focus has changed. Update the frames as necessary to reflect
3319 the new situation. Note that we can't change the selected frame
3320 here, because the Lisp code we are interrupting might become confused.
3321 Each event gets marked with the frame in which it occurred, so the
3322 Lisp code can tell when the switch took place by examining the events. */
3323
3324 static void
3325 x_new_focus_frame (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, struct frame *frame)
3326 {
3327 struct frame *old_focus = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3328
3329 if (frame != dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
3330 {
3331 /* Set this before calling other routines, so that they see
3332 the correct value of x_focus_frame. */
3333 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = frame;
3334
3335 if (old_focus && old_focus->auto_lower)
3336 x_lower_frame (old_focus);
3337
3338 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame && dpyinfo->x_focus_frame->auto_raise)
3339 pending_autoraise_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3340 else
3341 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
3342 }
3343
3344 x_frame_rehighlight (dpyinfo);
3345 }
3346
3347 /* Handle FocusIn and FocusOut state changes for FRAME.
3348 If FRAME has focus and there exists more than one frame, puts
3349 a FOCUS_IN_EVENT into *BUFP. */
3350
3351 static void
3352 x_focus_changed (int type, int state, struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, struct frame *frame, struct input_event *bufp)
3353 {
3354 if (type == FocusIn)
3355 {
3356 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame != frame)
3357 {
3358 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, frame);
3359 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = frame;
3360
3361 /* Don't stop displaying the initial startup message
3362 for a switch-frame event we don't need. */
3363 if (NILP (Vterminal_frame)
3364 && CONSP (Vframe_list)
3365 && !NILP (XCDR (Vframe_list)))
3366 {
3367 bufp->kind = FOCUS_IN_EVENT;
3368 XSETFRAME (bufp->frame_or_window, frame);
3369 }
3370 }
3371
3372 frame->output_data.x->focus_state |= state;
3373
3374 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
3375 if (FRAME_XIC (frame))
3376 XSetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (frame));
3377 #endif
3378 }
3379 else if (type == FocusOut)
3380 {
3381 frame->output_data.x->focus_state &= ~state;
3382
3383 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame == frame)
3384 {
3385 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
3386 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, 0);
3387 }
3388
3389 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
3390 if (FRAME_XIC (frame))
3391 XUnsetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (frame));
3392 #endif
3393 if (frame->pointer_invisible)
3394 XTtoggle_invisible_pointer (frame, 0);
3395 }
3396 }
3397
3398 /* The focus may have changed. Figure out if it is a real focus change,
3399 by checking both FocusIn/Out and Enter/LeaveNotify events.
3400
3401 Returns FOCUS_IN_EVENT event in *BUFP. */
3402
3403 static void
3404 x_detect_focus_change (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, XEvent *event, struct input_event *bufp)
3405 {
3406 struct frame *frame;
3407
3408 frame = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event->xany.window);
3409 if (! frame)
3410 return;
3411
3412 switch (event->type)
3413 {
3414 case EnterNotify:
3415 case LeaveNotify:
3416 {
3417 struct frame *focus_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame;
3418 int focus_state
3419 = focus_frame ? focus_frame->output_data.x->focus_state : 0;
3420
3421 if (event->xcrossing.detail != NotifyInferior
3422 && event->xcrossing.focus
3423 && ! (focus_state & FOCUS_EXPLICIT))
3424 x_focus_changed ((event->type == EnterNotify ? FocusIn : FocusOut),
3425 FOCUS_IMPLICIT,
3426 dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3427 }
3428 break;
3429
3430 case FocusIn:
3431 case FocusOut:
3432 x_focus_changed (event->type,
3433 (event->xfocus.detail == NotifyPointer ?
3434 FOCUS_IMPLICIT : FOCUS_EXPLICIT),
3435 dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3436 break;
3437
3438 case ClientMessage:
3439 if (event->xclient.message_type == dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED)
3440 {
3441 enum xembed_message msg = event->xclient.data.l[1];
3442 x_focus_changed ((msg == XEMBED_FOCUS_IN ? FocusIn : FocusOut),
3443 FOCUS_EXPLICIT, dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3444 }
3445 break;
3446 }
3447 }
3448
3449
3450 /* Handle an event saying the mouse has moved out of an Emacs frame. */
3451
3452 void
3453 x_mouse_leave (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
3454 {
3455 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame);
3456 }
3457
3458 /* The focus has changed, or we have redirected a frame's focus to
3459 another frame (this happens when a frame uses a surrogate
3460 mini-buffer frame). Shift the highlight as appropriate.
3461
3462 The FRAME argument doesn't necessarily have anything to do with which
3463 frame is being highlighted or un-highlighted; we only use it to find
3464 the appropriate X display info. */
3465
3466 static void
3467 XTframe_rehighlight (struct frame *frame)
3468 {
3469 x_frame_rehighlight (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (frame));
3470 }
3471
3472 static void
3473 x_frame_rehighlight (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
3474 {
3475 struct frame *old_highlight = dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame;
3476
3477 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
3478 {
3479 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame
3480 = ((FRAMEP (FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)))
3481 ? XFRAME (FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame))
3482 : dpyinfo->x_focus_frame);
3483 if (! FRAME_LIVE_P (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame))
3484 {
3485 FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame) = Qnil;
3486 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3487 }
3488 }
3489 else
3490 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
3491
3492 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame != old_highlight)
3493 {
3494 if (old_highlight)
3495 frame_unhighlight (old_highlight);
3496 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame)
3497 frame_highlight (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame);
3498 }
3499 }
3500
3501
3502 \f
3503 /* Keyboard processing - modifier keys, vendor-specific keysyms, etc. */
3504
3505 /* Initialize mode_switch_bit and modifier_meaning. */
3506 static void
3507 x_find_modifier_meanings (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
3508 {
3509 int min_code, max_code;
3510 KeySym *syms;
3511 int syms_per_code;
3512 XModifierKeymap *mods;
3513
3514 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask = 0;
3515 dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask = 0;
3516 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask = 0;
3517 dpyinfo->super_mod_mask = 0;
3518 dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask = 0;
3519
3520 XDisplayKeycodes (dpyinfo->display, &min_code, &max_code);
3521
3522 syms = XGetKeyboardMapping (dpyinfo->display,
3523 min_code, max_code - min_code + 1,
3524 &syms_per_code);
3525 mods = XGetModifierMapping (dpyinfo->display);
3526
3527 /* Scan the modifier table to see which modifier bits the Meta and
3528 Alt keysyms are on. */
3529 {
3530 int row, col; /* The row and column in the modifier table. */
3531 int found_alt_or_meta;
3532
3533 for (row = 3; row < 8; row++)
3534 {
3535 found_alt_or_meta = 0;
3536 for (col = 0; col < mods->max_keypermod; col++)
3537 {
3538 KeyCode code = mods->modifiermap[(row * mods->max_keypermod) + col];
3539
3540 /* Zeroes are used for filler. Skip them. */
3541 if (code == 0)
3542 continue;
3543
3544 /* Are any of this keycode's keysyms a meta key? */
3545 {
3546 int code_col;
3547
3548 for (code_col = 0; code_col < syms_per_code; code_col++)
3549 {
3550 int sym = syms[((code - min_code) * syms_per_code) + code_col];
3551
3552 switch (sym)
3553 {
3554 case XK_Meta_L:
3555 case XK_Meta_R:
3556 found_alt_or_meta = 1;
3557 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3558 break;
3559
3560 case XK_Alt_L:
3561 case XK_Alt_R:
3562 found_alt_or_meta = 1;
3563 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3564 break;
3565
3566 case XK_Hyper_L:
3567 case XK_Hyper_R:
3568 if (!found_alt_or_meta)
3569 dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3570 code_col = syms_per_code;
3571 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3572 break;
3573
3574 case XK_Super_L:
3575 case XK_Super_R:
3576 if (!found_alt_or_meta)
3577 dpyinfo->super_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3578 code_col = syms_per_code;
3579 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3580 break;
3581
3582 case XK_Shift_Lock:
3583 /* Ignore this if it's not on the lock modifier. */
3584 if (!found_alt_or_meta && ((1 << row) == LockMask))
3585 dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask = LockMask;
3586 code_col = syms_per_code;
3587 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3588 break;
3589 }
3590 }
3591 }
3592 }
3593 }
3594 }
3595
3596 /* If we couldn't find any meta keys, accept any alt keys as meta keys. */
3597 if (! dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
3598 {
3599 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask = dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask;
3600 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask = 0;
3601 }
3602
3603 /* If some keys are both alt and meta,
3604 make them just meta, not alt. */
3605 if (dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
3606 {
3607 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask &= ~dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask;
3608 }
3609
3610 XFree ((char *) syms);
3611 XFreeModifiermap (mods);
3612 }
3613
3614 /* Convert between the modifier bits X uses and the modifier bits
3615 Emacs uses. */
3616
3617 unsigned int
3618 x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, unsigned int state)
3619 {
3620 EMACS_UINT mod_meta = meta_modifier;
3621 EMACS_UINT mod_alt = alt_modifier;
3622 EMACS_UINT mod_hyper = hyper_modifier;
3623 EMACS_UINT mod_super = super_modifier;
3624 Lisp_Object tem;
3625
3626 tem = Fget (Vx_alt_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3627 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_alt = XUINT (tem);
3628 tem = Fget (Vx_meta_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3629 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_meta = XUINT (tem);
3630 tem = Fget (Vx_hyper_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3631 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_hyper = XUINT (tem);
3632 tem = Fget (Vx_super_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3633 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_super = XUINT (tem);
3634
3635
3636 return ( ((state & (ShiftMask | dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask)) ? shift_modifier : 0)
3637 | ((state & ControlMask) ? ctrl_modifier : 0)
3638 | ((state & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask) ? mod_meta : 0)
3639 | ((state & dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask) ? mod_alt : 0)
3640 | ((state & dpyinfo->super_mod_mask) ? mod_super : 0)
3641 | ((state & dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask) ? mod_hyper : 0));
3642 }
3643
3644 static unsigned int
3645 x_emacs_to_x_modifiers (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, unsigned int state)
3646 {
3647 EMACS_UINT mod_meta = meta_modifier;
3648 EMACS_UINT mod_alt = alt_modifier;
3649 EMACS_UINT mod_hyper = hyper_modifier;
3650 EMACS_UINT mod_super = super_modifier;
3651
3652 Lisp_Object tem;
3653
3654 tem = Fget (Vx_alt_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3655 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_alt = XUINT (tem);
3656 tem = Fget (Vx_meta_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3657 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_meta = XUINT (tem);
3658 tem = Fget (Vx_hyper_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3659 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_hyper = XUINT (tem);
3660 tem = Fget (Vx_super_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3661 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_super = XUINT (tem);
3662
3663
3664 return ( ((state & mod_alt) ? dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask : 0)
3665 | ((state & mod_super) ? dpyinfo->super_mod_mask : 0)
3666 | ((state & mod_hyper) ? dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask : 0)
3667 | ((state & shift_modifier) ? ShiftMask : 0)
3668 | ((state & ctrl_modifier) ? ControlMask : 0)
3669 | ((state & mod_meta) ? dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask : 0));
3670 }
3671
3672 /* Convert a keysym to its name. */
3673
3674 char *
3675 x_get_keysym_name (int keysym)
3676 {
3677 char *value;
3678
3679 BLOCK_INPUT;
3680 value = XKeysymToString (keysym);
3681 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3682
3683 return value;
3684 }
3685
3686
3687 \f
3688 /* Mouse clicks and mouse movement. Rah. */
3689
3690 /* Prepare a mouse-event in *RESULT for placement in the input queue.
3691
3692 If the event is a button press, then note that we have grabbed
3693 the mouse. */
3694
3695 static Lisp_Object
3696 construct_mouse_click (struct input_event *result, XButtonEvent *event, struct frame *f)
3697 {
3698 /* Make the event type NO_EVENT; we'll change that when we decide
3699 otherwise. */
3700 result->kind = MOUSE_CLICK_EVENT;
3701 result->code = event->button - Button1;
3702 result->timestamp = event->time;
3703 result->modifiers = (x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
3704 event->state)
3705 | (event->type == ButtonRelease
3706 ? up_modifier
3707 : down_modifier));
3708
3709 XSETINT (result->x, event->x);
3710 XSETINT (result->y, event->y);
3711 XSETFRAME (result->frame_or_window, f);
3712 result->arg = Qnil;
3713 return Qnil;
3714 }
3715
3716 \f
3717 /* Function to report a mouse movement to the mainstream Emacs code.
3718 The input handler calls this.
3719
3720 We have received a mouse movement event, which is given in *event.
3721 If the mouse is over a different glyph than it was last time, tell
3722 the mainstream emacs code by setting mouse_moved. If not, ask for
3723 another motion event, so we can check again the next time it moves. */
3724
3725 static XMotionEvent last_mouse_motion_event;
3726 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_motion_frame;
3727
3728 static int
3729 note_mouse_movement (FRAME_PTR frame, XMotionEvent *event)
3730 {
3731 last_mouse_movement_time = event->time;
3732 last_mouse_motion_event = *event;
3733 XSETFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame, frame);
3734
3735 if (!FRAME_X_OUTPUT (frame))
3736 return 0;
3737
3738 if (event->window != FRAME_X_WINDOW (frame))
3739 {
3740 frame->mouse_moved = 1;
3741 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3742 note_mouse_highlight (frame, -1, -1);
3743 last_mouse_glyph_frame = 0;
3744 return 1;
3745 }
3746
3747
3748 /* Has the mouse moved off the glyph it was on at the last sighting? */
3749 if (frame != last_mouse_glyph_frame
3750 || event->x < last_mouse_glyph.x
3751 || event->x >= last_mouse_glyph.x + last_mouse_glyph.width
3752 || event->y < last_mouse_glyph.y
3753 || event->y >= last_mouse_glyph.y + last_mouse_glyph.height)
3754 {
3755 frame->mouse_moved = 1;
3756 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3757 note_mouse_highlight (frame, event->x, event->y);
3758 /* Remember which glyph we're now on. */
3759 remember_mouse_glyph (frame, event->x, event->y, &last_mouse_glyph);
3760 last_mouse_glyph_frame = frame;
3761 return 1;
3762 }
3763
3764 return 0;
3765 }
3766
3767 \f
3768 /************************************************************************
3769 Mouse Face
3770 ************************************************************************/
3771
3772 static void
3773 redo_mouse_highlight (void)
3774 {
3775 if (!NILP (last_mouse_motion_frame)
3776 && FRAME_LIVE_P (XFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame)))
3777 note_mouse_highlight (XFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame),
3778 last_mouse_motion_event.x,
3779 last_mouse_motion_event.y);
3780 }
3781
3782
3783
3784 /* Return the current position of the mouse.
3785 *FP should be a frame which indicates which display to ask about.
3786
3787 If the mouse movement started in a scroll bar, set *FP, *BAR_WINDOW,
3788 and *PART to the frame, window, and scroll bar part that the mouse
3789 is over. Set *X and *Y to the portion and whole of the mouse's
3790 position on the scroll bar.
3791
3792 If the mouse movement started elsewhere, set *FP to the frame the
3793 mouse is on, *BAR_WINDOW to nil, and *X and *Y to the character cell
3794 the mouse is over.
3795
3796 Set *TIMESTAMP to the server time-stamp for the time at which the mouse
3797 was at this position.
3798
3799 Don't store anything if we don't have a valid set of values to report.
3800
3801 This clears the mouse_moved flag, so we can wait for the next mouse
3802 movement. */
3803
3804 static void
3805 XTmouse_position (FRAME_PTR *fp, int insist, Lisp_Object *bar_window,
3806 enum scroll_bar_part *part, Lisp_Object *x, Lisp_Object *y,
3807 long unsigned int *timestamp)
3808 {
3809 FRAME_PTR f1;
3810
3811 BLOCK_INPUT;
3812
3813 if (! NILP (last_mouse_scroll_bar) && insist == 0)
3814 x_scroll_bar_report_motion (fp, bar_window, part, x, y, timestamp);
3815 else
3816 {
3817 Window root;
3818 int root_x, root_y;
3819
3820 Window dummy_window;
3821 int dummy;
3822
3823 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
3824
3825 /* Clear the mouse-moved flag for every frame on this display. */
3826 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
3827 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
3828 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (frame)) == FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp))
3829 XFRAME (frame)->mouse_moved = 0;
3830
3831 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3832
3833 /* Figure out which root window we're on. */
3834 XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3835 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp)),
3836
3837 /* The root window which contains the pointer. */
3838 &root,
3839
3840 /* Trash which we can't trust if the pointer is on
3841 a different screen. */
3842 &dummy_window,
3843
3844 /* The position on that root window. */
3845 &root_x, &root_y,
3846
3847 /* More trash we can't trust. */
3848 &dummy, &dummy,
3849
3850 /* Modifier keys and pointer buttons, about which
3851 we don't care. */
3852 (unsigned int *) &dummy);
3853
3854 /* Now we have a position on the root; find the innermost window
3855 containing the pointer. */
3856 {
3857 Window win, child;
3858 int win_x, win_y;
3859 int parent_x = 0, parent_y = 0;
3860
3861 win = root;
3862
3863 /* XTranslateCoordinates can get errors if the window
3864 structure is changing at the same time this function
3865 is running. So at least we must not crash from them. */
3866
3867 x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp));
3868
3869 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp)->grabbed && last_mouse_frame
3870 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
3871 {
3872 /* If mouse was grabbed on a frame, give coords for that frame
3873 even if the mouse is now outside it. */
3874 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3875
3876 /* From-window, to-window. */
3877 root, FRAME_X_WINDOW (last_mouse_frame),
3878
3879 /* From-position, to-position. */
3880 root_x, root_y, &win_x, &win_y,
3881
3882 /* Child of win. */
3883 &child);
3884 f1 = last_mouse_frame;
3885 }
3886 else
3887 {
3888 while (1)
3889 {
3890 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3891
3892 /* From-window, to-window. */
3893 root, win,
3894
3895 /* From-position, to-position. */
3896 root_x, root_y, &win_x, &win_y,
3897
3898 /* Child of win. */
3899 &child);
3900
3901 if (child == None || child == win)
3902 break;
3903 #ifdef USE_GTK
3904 /* We don't wan't to know the innermost window. We
3905 want the edit window. For non-Gtk+ the innermost
3906 window is the edit window. For Gtk+ it might not
3907 be. It might be the tool bar for example. */
3908 if (x_window_to_frame (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp), win))
3909 break;
3910 #endif
3911 win = child;
3912 parent_x = win_x;
3913 parent_y = win_y;
3914 }
3915
3916 /* Now we know that:
3917 win is the innermost window containing the pointer
3918 (XTC says it has no child containing the pointer),
3919 win_x and win_y are the pointer's position in it
3920 (XTC did this the last time through), and
3921 parent_x and parent_y are the pointer's position in win's parent.
3922 (They are what win_x and win_y were when win was child.
3923 If win is the root window, it has no parent, and
3924 parent_{x,y} are invalid, but that's okay, because we'll
3925 never use them in that case.) */
3926
3927 #ifdef USE_GTK
3928 /* We don't wan't to know the innermost window. We
3929 want the edit window. */
3930 f1 = x_window_to_frame (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp), win);
3931 #else
3932 /* Is win one of our frames? */
3933 f1 = x_any_window_to_frame (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp), win);
3934 #endif
3935
3936 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
3937 /* If we end up with the menu bar window, say it's not
3938 on the frame. */
3939 if (f1 != NULL
3940 && f1->output_data.x->menubar_widget
3941 && win == XtWindow (f1->output_data.x->menubar_widget))
3942 f1 = NULL;
3943 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
3944 }
3945
3946 if (x_had_errors_p (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp)))
3947 f1 = 0;
3948
3949 x_uncatch_errors ();
3950
3951 /* If not, is it one of our scroll bars? */
3952 if (! f1)
3953 {
3954 struct scroll_bar *bar;
3955
3956 bar = x_window_to_scroll_bar (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp), win);
3957
3958 if (bar)
3959 {
3960 f1 = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
3961 win_x = parent_x;
3962 win_y = parent_y;
3963 }
3964 }
3965
3966 if (f1 == 0 && insist > 0)
3967 f1 = SELECTED_FRAME ();
3968
3969 if (f1)
3970 {
3971 /* Ok, we found a frame. Store all the values.
3972 last_mouse_glyph is a rectangle used to reduce the
3973 generation of mouse events. To not miss any motion
3974 events, we must divide the frame into rectangles of the
3975 size of the smallest character that could be displayed
3976 on it, i.e. into the same rectangles that matrices on
3977 the frame are divided into. */
3978
3979 remember_mouse_glyph (f1, win_x, win_y, &last_mouse_glyph);
3980 last_mouse_glyph_frame = f1;
3981
3982 *bar_window = Qnil;
3983 *part = 0;
3984 *fp = f1;
3985 XSETINT (*x, win_x);
3986 XSETINT (*y, win_y);
3987 *timestamp = last_mouse_movement_time;
3988 }
3989 }
3990 }
3991
3992 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3993 }
3994
3995
3996 \f
3997 /***********************************************************************
3998 Scroll bars
3999 ***********************************************************************/
4000
4001 /* Scroll bar support. */
4002
4003 /* Given an X window ID and a DISPLAY, find the struct scroll_bar which
4004 manages it.
4005 This can be called in GC, so we have to make sure to strip off mark
4006 bits. */
4007
4008 static struct scroll_bar *
4009 x_window_to_scroll_bar (Display *display, Window window_id)
4010 {
4011 Lisp_Object tail;
4012
4013 #if defined (USE_GTK) && defined (USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS)
4014 window_id = (Window) xg_get_scroll_id_for_window (display, window_id);
4015 #endif /* USE_GTK && USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4016
4017 for (tail = Vframe_list; CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
4018 {
4019 Lisp_Object frame, bar, condemned;
4020
4021 frame = XCAR (tail);
4022 /* All elements of Vframe_list should be frames. */
4023 if (! FRAMEP (frame))
4024 abort ();
4025
4026 if (! FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame)))
4027 continue;
4028
4029 /* Scan this frame's scroll bar list for a scroll bar with the
4030 right window ID. */
4031 condemned = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (frame));
4032 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (frame));
4033 /* This trick allows us to search both the ordinary and
4034 condemned scroll bar lists with one loop. */
4035 ! NILP (bar) || (bar = condemned,
4036 condemned = Qnil,
4037 ! NILP (bar));
4038 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next)
4039 if (XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->x_window == window_id &&
4040 FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (frame)) == display)
4041 return XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
4042 }
4043
4044 return 0;
4045 }
4046
4047
4048 #if defined USE_LUCID
4049
4050 /* Return the Lucid menu bar WINDOW is part of. Return null
4051 if WINDOW is not part of a menu bar. */
4052
4053 static Widget
4054 x_window_to_menu_bar (Window window)
4055 {
4056 Lisp_Object tail;
4057
4058 for (tail = Vframe_list; CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
4059 {
4060 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (XCAR (tail))))
4061 {
4062 Lisp_Object frame = XCAR (tail);
4063 Widget menu_bar = XFRAME (frame)->output_data.x->menubar_widget;
4064
4065 if (menu_bar && xlwmenu_window_p (menu_bar, window))
4066 return menu_bar;
4067 }
4068 }
4069
4070 return NULL;
4071 }
4072
4073 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
4074
4075 \f
4076 /************************************************************************
4077 Toolkit scroll bars
4078 ************************************************************************/
4079
4080 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4081
4082 static void x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (XEvent *, struct input_event *);
4083 static void x_send_scroll_bar_event (Lisp_Object, int, int, int);
4084 static void x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (struct frame *,
4085 struct scroll_bar *);
4086 static void x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (struct scroll_bar *,
4087 int, int, int);
4088
4089
4090 /* Lisp window being scrolled. Set when starting to interact with
4091 a toolkit scroll bar, reset to nil when ending the interaction. */
4092
4093 static Lisp_Object window_being_scrolled;
4094
4095 /* Last scroll bar part sent in xm_scroll_callback. */
4096
4097 static int last_scroll_bar_part;
4098
4099 /* Whether this is an Xaw with arrow-scrollbars. This should imply
4100 that movements of 1/20 of the screen size are mapped to up/down. */
4101
4102 #ifndef USE_GTK
4103 /* Id of action hook installed for scroll bars. */
4104
4105 static XtActionHookId action_hook_id;
4106
4107 static Boolean xaw3d_arrow_scroll;
4108
4109 /* Whether the drag scrolling maintains the mouse at the top of the
4110 thumb. If not, resizing the thumb needs to be done more carefully
4111 to avoid jerkyness. */
4112
4113 static Boolean xaw3d_pick_top;
4114
4115 /* Action hook installed via XtAppAddActionHook when toolkit scroll
4116 bars are used.. The hook is responsible for detecting when
4117 the user ends an interaction with the scroll bar, and generates
4118 a `end-scroll' SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT' event if so. */
4119
4120 static void
4121 xt_action_hook (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, String action_name,
4122 XEvent *event, String *params, Cardinal *num_params)
4123 {
4124 int scroll_bar_p;
4125 const char *end_action;
4126
4127 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4128 scroll_bar_p = XmIsScrollBar (widget);
4129 end_action = "Release";
4130 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4131 scroll_bar_p = XtIsSubclass (widget, scrollbarWidgetClass);
4132 end_action = "EndScroll";
4133 #endif /* USE_MOTIF */
4134
4135 if (scroll_bar_p
4136 && strcmp (action_name, end_action) == 0
4137 && WINDOWP (window_being_scrolled))
4138 {
4139 struct window *w;
4140
4141 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window_being_scrolled,
4142 scroll_bar_end_scroll, 0, 0);
4143 w = XWINDOW (window_being_scrolled);
4144
4145 if (!NILP (XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar)->dragging))
4146 {
4147 XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar)->dragging = Qnil;
4148 /* The thumb size is incorrect while dragging: fix it. */
4149 set_vertical_scroll_bar (w);
4150 }
4151 window_being_scrolled = Qnil;
4152 last_scroll_bar_part = -1;
4153
4154 /* Xt timeouts no longer needed. */
4155 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction = 0;
4156 }
4157 }
4158 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4159
4160 /* A vector of windows used for communication between
4161 x_send_scroll_bar_event and x_scroll_bar_to_input_event. */
4162
4163 static struct window **scroll_bar_windows;
4164 static int scroll_bar_windows_size;
4165
4166
4167 /* Send a client message with message type Xatom_Scrollbar for a
4168 scroll action to the frame of WINDOW. PART is a value identifying
4169 the part of the scroll bar that was clicked on. PORTION is the
4170 amount to scroll of a whole of WHOLE. */
4171
4172 static void
4173 x_send_scroll_bar_event (Lisp_Object window, int part, int portion, int whole)
4174 {
4175 XEvent event;
4176 XClientMessageEvent *ev = (XClientMessageEvent *) &event;
4177 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
4178 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4179 int i;
4180
4181 BLOCK_INPUT;
4182
4183 /* Construct a ClientMessage event to send to the frame. */
4184 ev->type = ClientMessage;
4185 ev->message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_Scrollbar;
4186 ev->display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
4187 ev->window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
4188 ev->format = 32;
4189
4190 /* We can only transfer 32 bits in the XClientMessageEvent, which is
4191 not enough to store a pointer or Lisp_Object on a 64 bit system.
4192 So, store the window in scroll_bar_windows and pass the index
4193 into that array in the event. */
4194 for (i = 0; i < scroll_bar_windows_size; ++i)
4195 if (scroll_bar_windows[i] == NULL)
4196 break;
4197
4198 if (i == scroll_bar_windows_size)
4199 {
4200 int new_size = max (10, 2 * scroll_bar_windows_size);
4201 size_t nbytes = new_size * sizeof *scroll_bar_windows;
4202 size_t old_nbytes = scroll_bar_windows_size * sizeof *scroll_bar_windows;
4203
4204 scroll_bar_windows = (struct window **) xrealloc (scroll_bar_windows,
4205 nbytes);
4206 memset (&scroll_bar_windows[i], 0, nbytes - old_nbytes);
4207 scroll_bar_windows_size = new_size;
4208 }
4209
4210 scroll_bar_windows[i] = w;
4211 ev->data.l[0] = (long) i;
4212 ev->data.l[1] = (long) part;
4213 ev->data.l[2] = (long) 0;
4214 ev->data.l[3] = (long) portion;
4215 ev->data.l[4] = (long) whole;
4216
4217 /* Make Xt timeouts work while the scroll bar is active. */
4218 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction = 1;
4219 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
4220 x_activate_timeout_atimer ();
4221 #endif
4222
4223 /* Setting the event mask to zero means that the message will
4224 be sent to the client that created the window, and if that
4225 window no longer exists, no event will be sent. */
4226 XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), False, 0, &event);
4227 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4228 }
4229
4230
4231 /* Transform a scroll bar ClientMessage EVENT to an Emacs input event
4232 in *IEVENT. */
4233
4234 static void
4235 x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (XEvent *event, struct input_event *ievent)
4236 {
4237 XClientMessageEvent *ev = (XClientMessageEvent *) event;
4238 Lisp_Object window;
4239 struct frame *f;
4240 struct window *w;
4241
4242 w = scroll_bar_windows[ev->data.l[0]];
4243 scroll_bar_windows[ev->data.l[0]] = NULL;
4244
4245 XSETWINDOW (window, w);
4246 f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4247
4248 ievent->kind = SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT;
4249 ievent->frame_or_window = window;
4250 ievent->arg = Qnil;
4251 #ifdef USE_GTK
4252 ievent->timestamp = CurrentTime;
4253 #else
4254 ievent->timestamp = XtLastTimestampProcessed (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
4255 #endif
4256 ievent->part = ev->data.l[1];
4257 ievent->code = ev->data.l[2];
4258 ievent->x = make_number ((int) ev->data.l[3]);
4259 ievent->y = make_number ((int) ev->data.l[4]);
4260 ievent->modifiers = 0;
4261 }
4262
4263
4264 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4265
4266 /* Minimum and maximum values used for Motif scroll bars. */
4267
4268 #define XM_SB_MAX 10000000
4269
4270
4271 /* Scroll bar callback for Motif scroll bars. WIDGET is the scroll
4272 bar widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure.
4273 CALL_DATA is a pointer to a XmScrollBarCallbackStruct. */
4274
4275 static void
4276 xm_scroll_callback (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, XtPointer call_data)
4277 {
4278 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4279 XmScrollBarCallbackStruct *cs = (XmScrollBarCallbackStruct *) call_data;
4280 int part = -1, whole = 0, portion = 0;
4281
4282 switch (cs->reason)
4283 {
4284 case XmCR_DECREMENT:
4285 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4286 part = scroll_bar_up_arrow;
4287 break;
4288
4289 case XmCR_INCREMENT:
4290 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4291 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4292 break;
4293
4294 case XmCR_PAGE_DECREMENT:
4295 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4296 part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
4297 break;
4298
4299 case XmCR_PAGE_INCREMENT:
4300 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4301 part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
4302 break;
4303
4304 case XmCR_TO_TOP:
4305 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4306 part = scroll_bar_to_top;
4307 break;
4308
4309 case XmCR_TO_BOTTOM:
4310 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4311 part = scroll_bar_to_bottom;
4312 break;
4313
4314 case XmCR_DRAG:
4315 {
4316 int slider_size;
4317
4318 /* Get the slider size. */
4319 BLOCK_INPUT;
4320 XtVaGetValues (widget, XmNsliderSize, &slider_size, NULL);
4321 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4322
4323 whole = XM_SB_MAX - slider_size;
4324 portion = min (cs->value, whole);
4325 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4326 bar->dragging = make_number (cs->value);
4327 }
4328 break;
4329
4330 case XmCR_VALUE_CHANGED:
4331 break;
4332 };
4333
4334 if (part >= 0)
4335 {
4336 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4337 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4338 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4339 }
4340 }
4341
4342 #elif defined USE_GTK
4343
4344 /* Scroll bar callback for GTK scroll bars. WIDGET is the scroll
4345 bar widget. DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure. */
4346
4347 static gboolean
4348 xg_scroll_callback (GtkRange *range,
4349 GtkScrollType scroll,
4350 gdouble value,
4351 gpointer user_data)
4352 {
4353 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) user_data;
4354 gdouble position;
4355 int part = -1, whole = 0, portion = 0;
4356 GtkAdjustment *adj = GTK_ADJUSTMENT (gtk_range_get_adjustment (range));
4357 FRAME_PTR f = (FRAME_PTR) g_object_get_data (G_OBJECT (range), XG_FRAME_DATA);
4358
4359 if (xg_ignore_gtk_scrollbar) return FALSE;
4360 position = gtk_adjustment_get_value (adj);
4361
4362
4363 switch (scroll)
4364 {
4365 case GTK_SCROLL_JUMP:
4366 /* Buttons 1 2 or 3 must be grabbed. */
4367 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->grabbed != 0
4368 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->grabbed < (1 << 4))
4369 {
4370 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4371 whole = gtk_adjustment_get_upper (adj) -
4372 gtk_adjustment_get_page_size (adj);
4373 portion = min ((int)position, whole);
4374 bar->dragging = make_number ((int)portion);
4375 }
4376 break;
4377 case GTK_SCROLL_STEP_BACKWARD:
4378 part = scroll_bar_up_arrow;
4379 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4380 break;
4381 case GTK_SCROLL_STEP_FORWARD:
4382 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4383 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4384 break;
4385 case GTK_SCROLL_PAGE_BACKWARD:
4386 part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
4387 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4388 break;
4389 case GTK_SCROLL_PAGE_FORWARD:
4390 part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
4391 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4392 break;
4393 }
4394
4395 if (part >= 0)
4396 {
4397 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4398 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4399 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4400 }
4401
4402 return FALSE;
4403 }
4404
4405 /* Callback for button release. Sets dragging to Qnil when dragging is done. */
4406
4407 static gboolean
4408 xg_end_scroll_callback (GtkWidget *widget,
4409 GdkEventButton *event,
4410 gpointer user_data)
4411 {
4412 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) user_data;
4413 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4414 if (WINDOWP (window_being_scrolled))
4415 {
4416 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window_being_scrolled,
4417 scroll_bar_end_scroll, 0, 0);
4418 window_being_scrolled = Qnil;
4419 }
4420
4421 return FALSE;
4422 }
4423
4424
4425 #else /* not USE_GTK and not USE_MOTIF */
4426
4427 /* Xaw scroll bar callback. Invoked when the thumb is dragged.
4428 WIDGET is the scroll bar widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the
4429 scroll bar struct. CALL_DATA is a pointer to a float saying where
4430 the thumb is. */
4431
4432 static void
4433 xaw_jump_callback (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, XtPointer call_data)
4434 {
4435 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4436 float top = *(float *) call_data;
4437 float shown;
4438 int whole, portion, height;
4439 int part;
4440
4441 /* Get the size of the thumb, a value between 0 and 1. */
4442 BLOCK_INPUT;
4443 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNshown, &shown, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
4444 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4445
4446 whole = 10000000;
4447 portion = shown < 1 ? top * whole : 0;
4448
4449 if (shown < 1 && (eabs (top + shown - 1) < 1.0/height))
4450 /* Some derivatives of Xaw refuse to shrink the thumb when you reach
4451 the bottom, so we force the scrolling whenever we see that we're
4452 too close to the bottom (in x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb
4453 we try to ensure that we always stay two pixels away from the
4454 bottom). */
4455 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4456 else
4457 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4458
4459 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4460 bar->dragging = make_number (portion);
4461 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4462 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4463 }
4464
4465
4466 /* Xaw scroll bar callback. Invoked for incremental scrolling.,
4467 i.e. line or page up or down. WIDGET is the Xaw scroll bar
4468 widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure for
4469 the scroll bar. CALL_DATA is an integer specifying the action that
4470 has taken place. Its magnitude is in the range 0..height of the
4471 scroll bar. Negative values mean scroll towards buffer start.
4472 Values < height of scroll bar mean line-wise movement. */
4473
4474 static void
4475 xaw_scroll_callback (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, XtPointer call_data)
4476 {
4477 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4478 /* The position really is stored cast to a pointer. */
4479 int position = (long) call_data;
4480 Dimension height;
4481 int part;
4482
4483 /* Get the height of the scroll bar. */
4484 BLOCK_INPUT;
4485 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
4486 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4487
4488 if (eabs (position) >= height)
4489 part = (position < 0) ? scroll_bar_above_handle : scroll_bar_below_handle;
4490
4491 /* If Xaw3d was compiled with ARROW_SCROLLBAR,
4492 it maps line-movement to call_data = max(5, height/20). */
4493 else if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll && eabs (position) <= max (5, height / 20))
4494 part = (position < 0) ? scroll_bar_up_arrow : scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4495 else
4496 part = scroll_bar_move_ratio;
4497
4498 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4499 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4500 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4501 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, position, height);
4502 }
4503
4504 #endif /* not USE_GTK and not USE_MOTIF */
4505
4506 #define SCROLL_BAR_NAME "verticalScrollBar"
4507
4508 /* Create the widget for scroll bar BAR on frame F. Record the widget
4509 and X window of the scroll bar in BAR. */
4510
4511 #ifdef USE_GTK
4512 static void
4513 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (struct frame *f, struct scroll_bar *bar)
4514 {
4515 const char *scroll_bar_name = SCROLL_BAR_NAME;
4516
4517 BLOCK_INPUT;
4518 xg_create_scroll_bar (f, bar, G_CALLBACK (xg_scroll_callback),
4519 G_CALLBACK (xg_end_scroll_callback),
4520 scroll_bar_name);
4521 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4522 }
4523
4524 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4525
4526 static void
4527 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (struct frame *f, struct scroll_bar *bar)
4528 {
4529 Window xwindow;
4530 Widget widget;
4531 Arg av[20];
4532 int ac = 0;
4533 char *scroll_bar_name = SCROLL_BAR_NAME;
4534 unsigned long pixel;
4535
4536 BLOCK_INPUT;
4537
4538 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4539 /* Set resources. Create the widget. */
4540 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNmappedWhenManaged, False); ++ac;
4541 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNminimum, 0); ++ac;
4542 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNmaximum, XM_SB_MAX); ++ac;
4543 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNorientation, XmVERTICAL); ++ac;
4544 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNprocessingDirection, XmMAX_ON_BOTTOM), ++ac;
4545 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNincrement, 1); ++ac;
4546 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNpageIncrement, 1); ++ac;
4547
4548 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel;
4549 if (pixel != -1)
4550 {
4551 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNforeground, pixel);
4552 ++ac;
4553 }
4554
4555 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4556 if (pixel != -1)
4557 {
4558 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNbackground, pixel);
4559 ++ac;
4560 }
4561
4562 widget = XmCreateScrollBar (f->output_data.x->edit_widget,
4563 scroll_bar_name, av, ac);
4564
4565 /* Add one callback for everything that can happen. */
4566 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNdecrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4567 (XtPointer) bar);
4568 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNdragCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4569 (XtPointer) bar);
4570 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNincrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4571 (XtPointer) bar);
4572 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNpageDecrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4573 (XtPointer) bar);
4574 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNpageIncrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4575 (XtPointer) bar);
4576 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNtoBottomCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4577 (XtPointer) bar);
4578 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNtoTopCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4579 (XtPointer) bar);
4580
4581 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
4582 XtRealizeWidget (widget);
4583
4584 /* Set the cursor to an arrow. I didn't find a resource to do that.
4585 And I'm wondering why it hasn't an arrow cursor by default. */
4586 XDefineCursor (XtDisplay (widget), XtWindow (widget),
4587 f->output_data.x->nontext_cursor);
4588
4589 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4590
4591 /* Set resources. Create the widget. The background of the
4592 Xaw3d scroll bar widget is a little bit light for my taste.
4593 We don't alter it here to let users change it according
4594 to their taste with `emacs*verticalScrollBar.background: xxx'. */
4595 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNmappedWhenManaged, False); ++ac;
4596 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNorientation, XtorientVertical); ++ac;
4597 /* For smoother scrolling with Xaw3d -sm */
4598 /* XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNpickTop, True); ++ac; */
4599
4600 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel;
4601 if (pixel != -1)
4602 {
4603 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNforeground, pixel);
4604 ++ac;
4605 }
4606
4607 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4608 if (pixel != -1)
4609 {
4610 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbackground, pixel);
4611 ++ac;
4612 }
4613
4614 /* Top/bottom shadow colors. */
4615
4616 /* Allocate them, if necessary. */
4617 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel == -1)
4618 {
4619 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4620 if (pixel != -1)
4621 {
4622 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
4623 FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f),
4624 &pixel, 1.2, 0x8000))
4625 pixel = -1;
4626 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel = pixel;
4627 }
4628 }
4629 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel == -1)
4630 {
4631 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4632 if (pixel != -1)
4633 {
4634 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
4635 FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f),
4636 &pixel, 0.6, 0x4000))
4637 pixel = -1;
4638 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel = pixel;
4639 }
4640 }
4641
4642 #ifdef XtNbeNiceToColormap
4643 /* Tell the toolkit about them. */
4644 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel == -1
4645 || f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel == -1)
4646 /* We tried to allocate a color for the top/bottom shadow, and
4647 failed, so tell Xaw3d to use dithering instead. */
4648 /* But only if we have a small colormap. Xaw3d can allocate nice
4649 colors itself. */
4650 {
4651 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbeNiceToColormap,
4652 DefaultDepthOfScreen (FRAME_X_SCREEN (f)) < 16);
4653 ++ac;
4654 }
4655 else
4656 /* Tell what colors Xaw3d should use for the top/bottom shadow, to
4657 be more consistent with other emacs 3d colors, and since Xaw3d is
4658 not good at dealing with allocation failure. */
4659 {
4660 /* This tells Xaw3d to use real colors instead of dithering for
4661 the shadows. */
4662 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbeNiceToColormap, False);
4663 ++ac;
4664
4665 /* Specify the colors. */
4666 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel;
4667 if (pixel != -1)
4668 {
4669 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNtopShadowPixel, pixel);
4670 ++ac;
4671 }
4672 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel;
4673 if (pixel != -1)
4674 {
4675 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbottomShadowPixel, pixel);
4676 ++ac;
4677 }
4678 }
4679 #endif
4680
4681 widget = XtCreateWidget (scroll_bar_name, scrollbarWidgetClass,
4682 f->output_data.x->edit_widget, av, ac);
4683
4684 {
4685 char *initial = "";
4686 char *val = initial;
4687 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNscrollVCursor, (XtPointer) &val,
4688 #ifdef XtNarrowScrollbars
4689 XtNarrowScrollbars, (XtPointer) &xaw3d_arrow_scroll,
4690 #endif
4691 XtNpickTop, (XtPointer) &xaw3d_pick_top, NULL);
4692 if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll || val == initial)
4693 { /* ARROW_SCROLL */
4694 xaw3d_arrow_scroll = True;
4695 /* Isn't that just a personal preference ? --Stef */
4696 XtVaSetValues (widget, XtNcursorName, "top_left_arrow", NULL);
4697 }
4698 }
4699
4700 /* Define callbacks. */
4701 XtAddCallback (widget, XtNjumpProc, xaw_jump_callback, (XtPointer) bar);
4702 XtAddCallback (widget, XtNscrollProc, xaw_scroll_callback,
4703 (XtPointer) bar);
4704
4705 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
4706 XtRealizeWidget (widget);
4707
4708 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
4709
4710 /* Install an action hook that lets us detect when the user
4711 finishes interacting with a scroll bar. */
4712 if (action_hook_id == 0)
4713 action_hook_id = XtAppAddActionHook (Xt_app_con, xt_action_hook, 0);
4714
4715 /* Remember X window and widget in the scroll bar vector. */
4716 SET_SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (bar, widget);
4717 xwindow = XtWindow (widget);
4718 bar->x_window = xwindow;
4719
4720 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4721 }
4722 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4723
4724
4725 /* Set the thumb size and position of scroll bar BAR. We are currently
4726 displaying PORTION out of a whole WHOLE, and our position POSITION. */
4727
4728 #ifdef USE_GTK
4729 static void
4730 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (struct scroll_bar *bar, int portion, int position, int whole)
4731 {
4732 xg_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole);
4733 }
4734
4735 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4736 static void
4737 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (struct scroll_bar *bar, int portion, int position,
4738 int whole)
4739 {
4740 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
4741 Widget widget = SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar);
4742 float top, shown;
4743
4744 BLOCK_INPUT;
4745
4746 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4747
4748 /* We use an estimate of 30 chars per line rather than the real
4749 `portion' value. This has the disadvantage that the thumb size
4750 is not very representative, but it makes our life a lot easier.
4751 Otherwise, we have to constantly adjust the thumb size, which
4752 we can't always do quickly enough: while dragging, the size of
4753 the thumb might prevent the user from dragging the thumb all the
4754 way to the end. but Motif and some versions of Xaw3d don't allow
4755 updating the thumb size while dragging. Also, even if we can update
4756 its size, the update will often happen too late.
4757 If you don't believe it, check out revision 1.650 of xterm.c to see
4758 what hoops we were going through and the still poor behavior we got. */
4759 portion = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (XWINDOW (bar->window)) * 30;
4760 /* When the thumb is at the bottom, position == whole.
4761 So we need to increase `whole' to make space for the thumb. */
4762 whole += portion;
4763
4764 if (whole <= 0)
4765 top = 0, shown = 1;
4766 else
4767 {
4768 top = (float) position / whole;
4769 shown = (float) portion / whole;
4770 }
4771
4772 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
4773 {
4774 int size, value;
4775
4776 /* Slider size. Must be in the range [1 .. MAX - MIN] where MAX
4777 is the scroll bar's maximum and MIN is the scroll bar's minimum
4778 value. */
4779 size = shown * XM_SB_MAX;
4780 size = min (size, XM_SB_MAX);
4781 size = max (size, 1);
4782
4783 /* Position. Must be in the range [MIN .. MAX - SLIDER_SIZE]. */
4784 value = top * XM_SB_MAX;
4785 value = min (value, XM_SB_MAX - size);
4786
4787 XmScrollBarSetValues (widget, value, size, 0, 0, False);
4788 }
4789 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4790
4791 if (whole == 0)
4792 top = 0, shown = 1;
4793 else
4794 {
4795 top = (float) position / whole;
4796 shown = (float) portion / whole;
4797 }
4798
4799 {
4800 float old_top, old_shown;
4801 Dimension height;
4802 XtVaGetValues (widget,
4803 XtNtopOfThumb, &old_top,
4804 XtNshown, &old_shown,
4805 XtNheight, &height,
4806 NULL);
4807
4808 /* Massage the top+shown values. */
4809 if (NILP (bar->dragging) || last_scroll_bar_part == scroll_bar_down_arrow)
4810 top = max (0, min (1, top));
4811 else
4812 top = old_top;
4813 /* Keep two pixels available for moving the thumb down. */
4814 shown = max (0, min (1 - top - (2.0 / height), shown));
4815
4816 /* If the call to XawScrollbarSetThumb below doesn't seem to work,
4817 check that your system's configuration file contains a define
4818 for `NARROWPROTO'. See s/freebsd.h for an example. */
4819 if (top != old_top || shown != old_shown)
4820 {
4821 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
4822 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget, top, shown);
4823 else
4824 {
4825 /* Try to make the scrolling a tad smoother. */
4826 if (!xaw3d_pick_top)
4827 shown = min (shown, old_shown);
4828
4829 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget, top, shown);
4830 }
4831 }
4832 }
4833 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
4834
4835 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4836 }
4837 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4838
4839 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4840
4841
4842 \f
4843 /************************************************************************
4844 Scroll bars, general
4845 ************************************************************************/
4846
4847 /* Create a scroll bar and return the scroll bar vector for it. W is
4848 the Emacs window on which to create the scroll bar. TOP, LEFT,
4849 WIDTH and HEIGHT are the pixel coordinates and dimensions of the
4850 scroll bar. */
4851
4852 static struct scroll_bar *
4853 x_scroll_bar_create (struct window *w, int top, int left, int width, int height)
4854 {
4855 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4856 struct scroll_bar *bar
4857 = ALLOCATE_PSEUDOVECTOR (struct scroll_bar, x_window, PVEC_OTHER);
4858
4859 BLOCK_INPUT;
4860
4861 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4862 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (f, bar);
4863 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4864 {
4865 XSetWindowAttributes a;
4866 unsigned long mask;
4867 Window window;
4868
4869 a.background_pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4870 if (a.background_pixel == -1)
4871 a.background_pixel = FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f);
4872
4873 a.event_mask = (ButtonPressMask | ButtonReleaseMask
4874 | ButtonMotionMask | PointerMotionHintMask
4875 | ExposureMask);
4876 a.cursor = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor;
4877
4878 mask = (CWBackPixel | CWEventMask | CWCursor);
4879
4880 /* Clear the area of W that will serve as a scroll bar. This is
4881 for the case that a window has been split horizontally. In
4882 this case, no clear_frame is generated to reduce flickering. */
4883 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
4884 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
4885 left, top, width,
4886 window_box_height (w), False);
4887
4888 window = XCreateWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
4889 /* Position and size of scroll bar. */
4890 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
4891 top,
4892 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
4893 height,
4894 /* Border width, depth, class, and visual. */
4895 0,
4896 CopyFromParent,
4897 CopyFromParent,
4898 CopyFromParent,
4899 /* Attributes. */
4900 mask, &a);
4901 bar->x_window = window;
4902 }
4903 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4904
4905 XSETWINDOW (bar->window, w);
4906 bar->top = top;
4907 bar->left = left;
4908 bar->width = width;
4909 bar->height = height;
4910 bar->start = 0;
4911 bar->end = 0;
4912 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4913 bar->fringe_extended_p = 0;
4914
4915 /* Add bar to its frame's list of scroll bars. */
4916 bar->next = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f);
4917 bar->prev = Qnil;
4918 XSETVECTOR (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), bar);
4919 if (!NILP (bar->next))
4920 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev, bar);
4921
4922 /* Map the window/widget. */
4923 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4924 {
4925 #ifdef USE_GTK
4926 xg_update_scrollbar_pos (f,
4927 bar->x_window,
4928 top,
4929 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
4930 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
4931 max (height, 1));
4932 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4933 Widget scroll_bar = SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar);
4934 XtConfigureWidget (scroll_bar,
4935 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
4936 top,
4937 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
4938 max (height, 1), 0);
4939 XtMapWidget (scroll_bar);
4940 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4941 }
4942 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4943 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar->x_window);
4944 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4945
4946 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4947 return bar;
4948 }
4949
4950
4951 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4952
4953 /* Draw BAR's handle in the proper position.
4954
4955 If the handle is already drawn from START to END, don't bother
4956 redrawing it, unless REBUILD is non-zero; in that case, always
4957 redraw it. (REBUILD is handy for drawing the handle after expose
4958 events.)
4959
4960 Normally, we want to constrain the start and end of the handle to
4961 fit inside its rectangle, but if the user is dragging the scroll
4962 bar handle, we want to let them drag it down all the way, so that
4963 the bar's top is as far down as it goes; otherwise, there's no way
4964 to move to the very end of the buffer. */
4965
4966 static void
4967 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (struct scroll_bar *bar, int start, int end, int rebuild)
4968 {
4969 int dragging = ! NILP (bar->dragging);
4970 Window w = bar->x_window;
4971 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
4972 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
4973
4974 /* If the display is already accurate, do nothing. */
4975 if (! rebuild
4976 && start == bar->start
4977 && end == bar->end)
4978 return;
4979
4980 BLOCK_INPUT;
4981
4982 {
4983 int inside_width = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_WIDTH (f, bar->width);
4984 int inside_height = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_HEIGHT (f, bar->height);
4985 int top_range = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, bar->height);
4986
4987 /* Make sure the values are reasonable, and try to preserve
4988 the distance between start and end. */
4989 {
4990 int length = end - start;
4991
4992 if (start < 0)
4993 start = 0;
4994 else if (start > top_range)
4995 start = top_range;
4996 end = start + length;
4997
4998 if (end < start)
4999 end = start;
5000 else if (end > top_range && ! dragging)
5001 end = top_range;
5002 }
5003
5004 /* Store the adjusted setting in the scroll bar. */
5005 bar->start = start;
5006 bar->end = end;
5007
5008 /* Clip the end position, just for display. */
5009 if (end > top_range)
5010 end = top_range;
5011
5012 /* Draw bottom positions VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE pixels
5013 below top positions, to make sure the handle is always at least
5014 that many pixels tall. */
5015 end += VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE;
5016
5017 /* Draw the empty space above the handle. Note that we can't clear
5018 zero-height areas; that means "clear to end of window." */
5019 if (0 < start)
5020 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
5021 /* x, y, width, height, and exposures. */
5022 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
5023 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER,
5024 inside_width, start,
5025 False);
5026
5027 /* Change to proper foreground color if one is specified. */
5028 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5029 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5030 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
5031
5032 /* Draw the handle itself. */
5033 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w, gc,
5034 /* x, y, width, height */
5035 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
5036 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER + start,
5037 inside_width, end - start);
5038
5039 /* Restore the foreground color of the GC if we changed it above. */
5040 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5041 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5042 FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f));
5043
5044 /* Draw the empty space below the handle. Note that we can't
5045 clear zero-height areas; that means "clear to end of window." */
5046 if (end < inside_height)
5047 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
5048 /* x, y, width, height, and exposures. */
5049 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
5050 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER + end,
5051 inside_width, inside_height - end,
5052 False);
5053
5054 }
5055
5056 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5057 }
5058
5059 #endif /* !USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5060
5061 /* Destroy scroll bar BAR, and set its Emacs window's scroll bar to
5062 nil. */
5063
5064 static void
5065 x_scroll_bar_remove (struct scroll_bar *bar)
5066 {
5067 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5068 BLOCK_INPUT;
5069
5070 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5071 #ifdef USE_GTK
5072 xg_remove_scroll_bar (f, bar->x_window);
5073 #else /* not USE_GTK */
5074 XtDestroyWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar));
5075 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5076 #else
5077 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar->x_window);
5078 #endif
5079
5080 /* Disassociate this scroll bar from its window. */
5081 XWINDOW (bar->window)->vertical_scroll_bar = Qnil;
5082
5083 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5084 }
5085
5086
5087 /* Set the handle of the vertical scroll bar for WINDOW to indicate
5088 that we are displaying PORTION characters out of a total of WHOLE
5089 characters, starting at POSITION. If WINDOW has no scroll bar,
5090 create one. */
5091
5092 static void
5093 XTset_vertical_scroll_bar (struct window *w, int portion, int whole, int position)
5094 {
5095 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
5096 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5097 int top, height, left, sb_left, width, sb_width;
5098 int window_y, window_height;
5099 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5100 int fringe_extended_p;
5101 #endif
5102
5103 /* Get window dimensions. */
5104 window_box (w, -1, 0, &window_y, 0, &window_height);
5105 top = window_y;
5106 width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
5107 height = window_height;
5108
5109 /* Compute the left edge of the scroll bar area. */
5110 left = WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_X (w);
5111
5112 /* Compute the width of the scroll bar which might be less than
5113 the width of the area reserved for the scroll bar. */
5114 if (WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w) > 0)
5115 sb_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w);
5116 else
5117 sb_width = width;
5118
5119 /* Compute the left edge of the scroll bar. */
5120 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5121 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w))
5122 sb_left = left + (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w) ? width - sb_width : 0);
5123 else
5124 sb_left = left + (WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w) ? 0 : width - sb_width);
5125 #else
5126 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w))
5127 sb_left = left + width - sb_width;
5128 else
5129 sb_left = left;
5130 #endif
5131
5132 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5133 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
5134 fringe_extended_p = (WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w)
5135 && WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w)
5136 && (WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (w)
5137 || WINDOW_LEFT_MARGIN_COLS (w) == 0));
5138 else
5139 fringe_extended_p = (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w)
5140 && WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w)
5141 && (WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (w)
5142 || WINDOW_RIGHT_MARGIN_COLS (w) == 0));
5143 #endif
5144
5145 /* Does the scroll bar exist yet? */
5146 if (NILP (w->vertical_scroll_bar))
5147 {
5148 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
5149 {
5150 BLOCK_INPUT;
5151 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5152 if (fringe_extended_p)
5153 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5154 sb_left, top, sb_width, height, False);
5155 else
5156 #endif
5157 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5158 left, top, width, height, False);
5159 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5160 }
5161
5162 bar = x_scroll_bar_create (w, top, sb_left, sb_width, height);
5163 }
5164 else
5165 {
5166 /* It may just need to be moved and resized. */
5167 unsigned int mask = 0;
5168
5169 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar);
5170
5171 BLOCK_INPUT;
5172
5173 if (sb_left != bar->left)
5174 mask |= CWX;
5175 if (top != bar->top)
5176 mask |= CWY;
5177 if (sb_width != bar->width)
5178 mask |= CWWidth;
5179 if (height != bar->height)
5180 mask |= CWHeight;
5181
5182 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5183
5184 /* Move/size the scroll bar widget. */
5185 if (mask || bar->fringe_extended_p != fringe_extended_p)
5186 {
5187 /* Since toolkit scroll bars are smaller than the space reserved
5188 for them on the frame, we have to clear "under" them. */
5189 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
5190 {
5191 if (fringe_extended_p)
5192 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5193 sb_left, top, sb_width, height, False);
5194 else
5195 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5196 left, top, width, height, False);
5197 }
5198 #ifdef USE_GTK
5199 xg_update_scrollbar_pos (f,
5200 bar->x_window,
5201 top,
5202 sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5203 sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM *2,
5204 max (height, 1));
5205 #else /* not USE_GTK */
5206 XtConfigureWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar),
5207 sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5208 top,
5209 sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
5210 max (height, 1), 0);
5211 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5212 }
5213 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5214
5215 /* Clear areas not covered by the scroll bar because of
5216 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM. */
5217 if (VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM)
5218 {
5219 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5220 left, top, VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5221 height, False);
5222 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5223 left + width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5224 top, VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5225 height, False);
5226 }
5227
5228 /* Clear areas not covered by the scroll bar because it's not as
5229 wide as the area reserved for it. This makes sure a
5230 previous mode line display is cleared after C-x 2 C-x 1, for
5231 example. */
5232 {
5233 int area_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
5234 int rest = area_width - sb_width;
5235 if (rest > 0 && height > 0)
5236 {
5237 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
5238 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5239 left + area_width - rest, top,
5240 rest, height, False);
5241 else
5242 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5243 left, top, rest, height, False);
5244 }
5245 }
5246
5247 /* Move/size the scroll bar window. */
5248 if (mask)
5249 {
5250 XWindowChanges wc;
5251
5252 wc.x = sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
5253 wc.y = top;
5254 wc.width = sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2;
5255 wc.height = height;
5256 XConfigureWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar->x_window,
5257 mask, &wc);
5258 }
5259
5260 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5261
5262 /* Remember new settings. */
5263 bar->left = sb_left;
5264 bar->top = top;
5265 bar->width = sb_width;
5266 bar->height = height;
5267
5268 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5269 }
5270
5271 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5272 bar->fringe_extended_p = fringe_extended_p;
5273
5274 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole);
5275 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5276 /* Set the scroll bar's current state, unless we're currently being
5277 dragged. */
5278 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
5279 {
5280 int top_range = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, height);
5281
5282 if (whole == 0)
5283 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, 0, top_range, 0);
5284 else
5285 {
5286 int start = ((double) position * top_range) / whole;
5287 int end = ((double) (position + portion) * top_range) / whole;
5288 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, start, end, 0);
5289 }
5290 }
5291 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5292
5293 XSETVECTOR (w->vertical_scroll_bar, bar);
5294 }
5295
5296
5297 /* The following three hooks are used when we're doing a thorough
5298 redisplay of the frame. We don't explicitly know which scroll bars
5299 are going to be deleted, because keeping track of when windows go
5300 away is a real pain - "Can you say set-window-configuration, boys
5301 and girls?" Instead, we just assert at the beginning of redisplay
5302 that *all* scroll bars are to be removed, and then save a scroll bar
5303 from the fiery pit when we actually redisplay its window. */
5304
5305 /* Arrange for all scroll bars on FRAME to be removed at the next call
5306 to `*judge_scroll_bars_hook'. A scroll bar may be spared if
5307 `*redeem_scroll_bar_hook' is applied to its window before the judgment. */
5308
5309 static void
5310 XTcondemn_scroll_bars (FRAME_PTR frame)
5311 {
5312 /* Transfer all the scroll bars to FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS. */
5313 while (! NILP (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame)))
5314 {
5315 Lisp_Object bar;
5316 bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame);
5317 FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame) = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next;
5318 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame);
5319 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->prev = Qnil;
5320 if (! NILP (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame)))
5321 XSCROLL_BAR (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame))->prev = bar;
5322 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame) = bar;
5323 }
5324 }
5325
5326
5327 /* Un-mark WINDOW's scroll bar for deletion in this judgment cycle.
5328 Note that WINDOW isn't necessarily condemned at all. */
5329
5330 static void
5331 XTredeem_scroll_bar (struct window *window)
5332 {
5333 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5334 struct frame *f;
5335
5336 /* We can't redeem this window's scroll bar if it doesn't have one. */
5337 if (NILP (window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5338 abort ();
5339
5340 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (window->vertical_scroll_bar);
5341
5342 /* Unlink it from the condemned list. */
5343 f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (window));
5344 if (NILP (bar->prev))
5345 {
5346 /* If the prev pointer is nil, it must be the first in one of
5347 the lists. */
5348 if (EQ (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5349 /* It's not condemned. Everything's fine. */
5350 return;
5351 else if (EQ (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f),
5352 window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5353 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f) = bar->next;
5354 else
5355 /* If its prev pointer is nil, it must be at the front of
5356 one or the other! */
5357 abort ();
5358 }
5359 else
5360 XSCROLL_BAR (bar->prev)->next = bar->next;
5361
5362 if (! NILP (bar->next))
5363 XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev = bar->prev;
5364
5365 bar->next = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f);
5366 bar->prev = Qnil;
5367 XSETVECTOR (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), bar);
5368 if (! NILP (bar->next))
5369 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev, bar);
5370 }
5371
5372 /* Remove all scroll bars on FRAME that haven't been saved since the
5373 last call to `*condemn_scroll_bars_hook'. */
5374
5375 static void
5376 XTjudge_scroll_bars (FRAME_PTR f)
5377 {
5378 Lisp_Object bar, next;
5379
5380 bar = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f);
5381
5382 /* Clear out the condemned list now so we won't try to process any
5383 more events on the hapless scroll bars. */
5384 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f) = Qnil;
5385
5386 for (; ! NILP (bar); bar = next)
5387 {
5388 struct scroll_bar *b = XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
5389
5390 x_scroll_bar_remove (b);
5391
5392 next = b->next;
5393 b->next = b->prev = Qnil;
5394 }
5395
5396 /* Now there should be no references to the condemned scroll bars,
5397 and they should get garbage-collected. */
5398 }
5399
5400
5401 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5402 /* Handle an Expose or GraphicsExpose event on a scroll bar. This
5403 is a no-op when using toolkit scroll bars.
5404
5405 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5406 mark bits. */
5407
5408 static void
5409 x_scroll_bar_expose (struct scroll_bar *bar, XEvent *event)
5410 {
5411 Window w = bar->x_window;
5412 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5413 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
5414 int width_trim = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
5415
5416 BLOCK_INPUT;
5417
5418 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, bar->start, bar->end, 1);
5419
5420 /* Switch to scroll bar foreground color. */
5421 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5422 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5423 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
5424
5425 /* Draw a one-pixel border just inside the edges of the scroll bar. */
5426 XDrawRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w, gc,
5427
5428 /* x, y, width, height */
5429 0, 0,
5430 bar->width - 1 - width_trim - width_trim,
5431 bar->height - 1);
5432
5433 /* Restore the foreground color of the GC if we changed it above. */
5434 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5435 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5436 FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f));
5437
5438 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5439
5440 }
5441 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5442
5443 /* Handle a mouse click on the scroll bar BAR. If *EMACS_EVENT's kind
5444 is set to something other than NO_EVENT, it is enqueued.
5445
5446 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5447 mark bits. */
5448
5449
5450 static void
5451 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (struct scroll_bar *bar, XEvent *event, struct input_event *emacs_event)
5452 {
5453 if (! WINDOWP (bar->window))
5454 abort ();
5455
5456 emacs_event->kind = SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT;
5457 emacs_event->code = event->xbutton.button - Button1;
5458 emacs_event->modifiers
5459 = (x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO
5460 (XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)))),
5461 event->xbutton.state)
5462 | (event->type == ButtonRelease
5463 ? up_modifier
5464 : down_modifier));
5465 emacs_event->frame_or_window = bar->window;
5466 emacs_event->arg = Qnil;
5467 emacs_event->timestamp = event->xbutton.time;
5468 {
5469 int top_range
5470 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, bar->height);
5471 int y = event->xbutton.y - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER;
5472
5473 if (y < 0) y = 0;
5474 if (y > top_range) y = top_range;
5475
5476 if (y < bar->start)
5477 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
5478 else if (y < bar->end + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE)
5479 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_handle;
5480 else
5481 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
5482
5483 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5484 /* If the user has released the handle, set it to its final position. */
5485 if (event->type == ButtonRelease
5486 && ! NILP (bar->dragging))
5487 {
5488 int new_start = y - XINT (bar->dragging);
5489 int new_end = new_start + bar->end - bar->start;
5490
5491 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, new_start, new_end, 0);
5492 bar->dragging = Qnil;
5493 }
5494 #endif
5495
5496 XSETINT (emacs_event->x, y);
5497 XSETINT (emacs_event->y, top_range);
5498 }
5499 }
5500
5501 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5502
5503 /* Handle some mouse motion while someone is dragging the scroll bar.
5504
5505 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5506 mark bits. */
5507
5508 static void
5509 x_scroll_bar_note_movement (struct scroll_bar *bar, XEvent *event)
5510 {
5511 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)->frame);
5512
5513 last_mouse_movement_time = event->xmotion.time;
5514
5515 f->mouse_moved = 1;
5516 XSETVECTOR (last_mouse_scroll_bar, bar);
5517
5518 /* If we're dragging the bar, display it. */
5519 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5520 {
5521 /* Where should the handle be now? */
5522 int new_start = event->xmotion.y - XINT (bar->dragging);
5523
5524 if (new_start != bar->start)
5525 {
5526 int new_end = new_start + bar->end - bar->start;
5527
5528 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, new_start, new_end, 0);
5529 }
5530 }
5531 }
5532
5533 #endif /* !USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5534
5535 /* Return information to the user about the current position of the mouse
5536 on the scroll bar. */
5537
5538 static void
5539 x_scroll_bar_report_motion (FRAME_PTR *fp, Lisp_Object *bar_window,
5540 enum scroll_bar_part *part, Lisp_Object *x,
5541 Lisp_Object *y, long unsigned int *timestamp)
5542 {
5543 struct scroll_bar *bar = XSCROLL_BAR (last_mouse_scroll_bar);
5544 Window w = bar->x_window;
5545 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5546 int win_x, win_y;
5547 Window dummy_window;
5548 int dummy_coord;
5549 unsigned int dummy_mask;
5550
5551 BLOCK_INPUT;
5552
5553 /* Get the mouse's position relative to the scroll bar window, and
5554 report that. */
5555 if (! XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
5556
5557 /* Root, child, root x and root y. */
5558 &dummy_window, &dummy_window,
5559 &dummy_coord, &dummy_coord,
5560
5561 /* Position relative to scroll bar. */
5562 &win_x, &win_y,
5563
5564 /* Mouse buttons and modifier keys. */
5565 &dummy_mask))
5566 ;
5567 else
5568 {
5569 int top_range
5570 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, bar->height);
5571
5572 win_y -= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER;
5573
5574 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5575 win_y -= XINT (bar->dragging);
5576
5577 if (win_y < 0)
5578 win_y = 0;
5579 if (win_y > top_range)
5580 win_y = top_range;
5581
5582 *fp = f;
5583 *bar_window = bar->window;
5584
5585 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5586 *part = scroll_bar_handle;
5587 else if (win_y < bar->start)
5588 *part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
5589 else if (win_y < bar->end + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE)
5590 *part = scroll_bar_handle;
5591 else
5592 *part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
5593
5594 XSETINT (*x, win_y);
5595 XSETINT (*y, top_range);
5596
5597 f->mouse_moved = 0;
5598 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
5599 }
5600
5601 *timestamp = last_mouse_movement_time;
5602
5603 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5604 }
5605
5606
5607 /* The screen has been cleared so we may have changed foreground or
5608 background colors, and the scroll bars may need to be redrawn.
5609 Clear out the scroll bars, and ask for expose events, so we can
5610 redraw them. */
5611
5612 static void
5613 x_scroll_bar_clear (FRAME_PTR f)
5614 {
5615 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5616 Lisp_Object bar;
5617
5618 /* We can have scroll bars even if this is 0,
5619 if we just turned off scroll bar mode.
5620 But in that case we should not clear them. */
5621 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f))
5622 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f); VECTORP (bar);
5623 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next)
5624 XClearArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5625 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->x_window,
5626 0, 0, 0, 0, True);
5627 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5628 }
5629
5630 \f
5631 /* The main X event-reading loop - XTread_socket. */
5632
5633 /* This holds the state XLookupString needs to implement dead keys
5634 and other tricks known as "compose processing". _X Window System_
5635 says that a portable program can't use this, but Stephen Gildea assures
5636 me that letting the compiler initialize it to zeros will work okay.
5637
5638 This must be defined outside of XTread_socket, for the same reasons
5639 given for enter_timestamp, above. */
5640
5641 static XComposeStatus compose_status;
5642
5643 /* Record the last 100 characters stored
5644 to help debug the loss-of-chars-during-GC problem. */
5645
5646 static int temp_index;
5647 static short temp_buffer[100];
5648
5649 #define STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG(keysym) \
5650 if (temp_index == sizeof temp_buffer / sizeof (short)) \
5651 temp_index = 0; \
5652 temp_buffer[temp_index++] = (keysym)
5653
5654 /* Set this to nonzero to fake an "X I/O error"
5655 on a particular display. */
5656
5657 struct x_display_info *XTread_socket_fake_io_error;
5658
5659 /* When we find no input here, we occasionally do a no-op command
5660 to verify that the X server is still running and we can still talk with it.
5661 We try all the open displays, one by one.
5662 This variable is used for cycling thru the displays. */
5663
5664 static struct x_display_info *next_noop_dpyinfo;
5665
5666 #define SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT \
5667 do \
5668 { \
5669 if (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event == 0) \
5670 f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event \
5671 = (XEvent *) xmalloc (sizeof (XEvent)); \
5672 *f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event = event; \
5673 inev.ie.kind = MENU_BAR_ACTIVATE_EVENT; \
5674 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f); \
5675 } \
5676 while (0)
5677
5678 enum
5679 {
5680 X_EVENT_NORMAL,
5681 X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT,
5682 X_EVENT_DROP
5683 };
5684
5685 /* Filter events for the current X input method.
5686 DPYINFO is the display this event is for.
5687 EVENT is the X event to filter.
5688
5689 Returns non-zero if the event was filtered, caller shall not process
5690 this event further.
5691 Returns zero if event is wasn't filtered. */
5692
5693 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5694 static int
5695 x_filter_event (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, XEvent *event)
5696 {
5697 /* XFilterEvent returns non-zero if the input method has
5698 consumed the event. We pass the frame's X window to
5699 XFilterEvent because that's the one for which the IC
5700 was created. */
5701
5702 struct frame *f1 = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5703 event->xclient.window);
5704
5705 return XFilterEvent (event, f1 ? FRAME_X_WINDOW (f1) : None);
5706 }
5707 #endif
5708
5709 #ifdef USE_GTK
5710 static int current_count;
5711 static int current_finish;
5712 static struct input_event *current_hold_quit;
5713
5714 /* This is the filter function invoked by the GTK event loop.
5715 It is invoked before the XEvent is translated to a GdkEvent,
5716 so we have a chance to act on the event before GTK. */
5717 static GdkFilterReturn
5718 event_handler_gdk (GdkXEvent *gxev, GdkEvent *ev, gpointer data)
5719 {
5720 XEvent *xev = (XEvent *) gxev;
5721
5722 BLOCK_INPUT;
5723 if (current_count >= 0)
5724 {
5725 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
5726
5727 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (xev->xany.display);
5728
5729 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5730 /* Filter events for the current X input method.
5731 GTK calls XFilterEvent but not for key press and release,
5732 so we do it here. */
5733 if ((xev->type == KeyPress || xev->type == KeyRelease)
5734 && dpyinfo
5735 && x_filter_event (dpyinfo, xev))
5736 {
5737 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5738 return GDK_FILTER_REMOVE;
5739 }
5740 #endif
5741
5742 if (! dpyinfo)
5743 current_finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
5744 else
5745 current_count +=
5746 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, xev, &current_finish,
5747 current_hold_quit);
5748 }
5749 else
5750 current_finish = x_dispatch_event (xev, xev->xany.display);
5751
5752 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5753
5754 if (current_finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT || current_finish == X_EVENT_DROP)
5755 return GDK_FILTER_REMOVE;
5756
5757 return GDK_FILTER_CONTINUE;
5758 }
5759 #endif /* USE_GTK */
5760
5761
5762 static void xembed_send_message (struct frame *f, Time time,
5763 enum xembed_message message,
5764 long detail, long data1, long data2);
5765
5766 /* Handles the XEvent EVENT on display DPYINFO.
5767
5768 *FINISH is X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT if caller should stop reading events.
5769 *FINISH is zero if caller should continue reading events.
5770 *FINISH is X_EVENT_DROP if event should not be passed to the toolkit.
5771
5772 We return the number of characters stored into the buffer. */
5773
5774 static int
5775 handle_one_xevent (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, XEvent *eventptr,
5776 int *finish, struct input_event *hold_quit)
5777 {
5778 union {
5779 struct input_event ie;
5780 struct selection_input_event sie;
5781 } inev;
5782 int count = 0;
5783 int do_help = 0;
5784 int nbytes = 0;
5785 struct frame *f = NULL;
5786 struct coding_system coding;
5787 XEvent event = *eventptr;
5788 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = &dpyinfo->mouse_highlight;
5789
5790 *finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
5791
5792 EVENT_INIT (inev.ie);
5793 inev.ie.kind = NO_EVENT;
5794 inev.ie.arg = Qnil;
5795
5796 if (pending_event_wait.eventtype == event.type)
5797 pending_event_wait.eventtype = 0; /* Indicates we got it. */
5798
5799 switch (event.type)
5800 {
5801 case ClientMessage:
5802 {
5803 if (event.xclient.message_type
5804 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_protocols
5805 && event.xclient.format == 32)
5806 {
5807 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5808 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_take_focus)
5809 {
5810 /* Use x_any_window_to_frame because this
5811 could be the shell widget window
5812 if the frame has no title bar. */
5813 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5814 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5815 /* Not quite sure this is needed -pd */
5816 if (f && FRAME_XIC (f))
5817 XSetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (f));
5818 #endif
5819 #if 0 /* Emacs sets WM hints whose `input' field is `true'. This
5820 instructs the WM to set the input focus automatically for
5821 Emacs with a call to XSetInputFocus. Setting WM_TAKE_FOCUS
5822 tells the WM to send us a ClientMessage WM_TAKE_FOCUS after
5823 it has set the focus. So, XSetInputFocus below is not
5824 needed.
5825
5826 The call to XSetInputFocus below has also caused trouble. In
5827 cases where the XSetInputFocus done by the WM and the one
5828 below are temporally close (on a fast machine), the call
5829 below can generate additional FocusIn events which confuse
5830 Emacs. */
5831
5832 /* Since we set WM_TAKE_FOCUS, we must call
5833 XSetInputFocus explicitly. But not if f is null,
5834 since that might be an event for a deleted frame. */
5835 if (f)
5836 {
5837 Display *d = event.xclient.display;
5838 /* Catch and ignore errors, in case window has been
5839 iconified by a window manager such as GWM. */
5840 x_catch_errors (d);
5841 XSetInputFocus (d, event.xclient.window,
5842 /* The ICCCM says this is
5843 the only valid choice. */
5844 RevertToParent,
5845 event.xclient.data.l[1]);
5846 /* This is needed to detect the error
5847 if there is an error. */
5848 XSync (d, False);
5849 x_uncatch_errors ();
5850 }
5851 /* Not certain about handling scroll bars here */
5852 #endif /* 0 */
5853 goto done;
5854 }
5855
5856 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5857 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_save_yourself)
5858 {
5859 /* Save state modify the WM_COMMAND property to
5860 something which can reinstate us. This notifies
5861 the session manager, who's looking for such a
5862 PropertyNotify. Can restart processing when
5863 a keyboard or mouse event arrives. */
5864 /* If we have a session manager, don't set this.
5865 KDE will then start two Emacsen, one for the
5866 session manager and one for this. */
5867 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
5868 if (! x_session_have_connection ())
5869 #endif
5870 {
5871 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5872 event.xclient.window);
5873 /* This is just so we only give real data once
5874 for a single Emacs process. */
5875 if (f == SELECTED_FRAME ())
5876 XSetCommand (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5877 event.xclient.window,
5878 initial_argv, initial_argc);
5879 else if (f)
5880 XSetCommand (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5881 event.xclient.window,
5882 0, 0);
5883 }
5884 goto done;
5885 }
5886
5887 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5888 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_delete_window)
5889 {
5890 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5891 event.xclient.window);
5892 if (!f)
5893 goto OTHER; /* May be a dialog that is to be removed */
5894
5895 inev.ie.kind = DELETE_WINDOW_EVENT;
5896 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
5897 goto done;
5898 }
5899
5900 goto done;
5901 }
5902
5903 if (event.xclient.message_type
5904 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_configure_denied)
5905 {
5906 goto done;
5907 }
5908
5909 if (event.xclient.message_type
5910 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_window_moved)
5911 {
5912 int new_x, new_y;
5913 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5914
5915 new_x = event.xclient.data.s[0];
5916 new_y = event.xclient.data.s[1];
5917
5918 if (f)
5919 {
5920 f->left_pos = new_x;
5921 f->top_pos = new_y;
5922 }
5923 goto done;
5924 }
5925
5926 #ifdef HACK_EDITRES
5927 if (event.xclient.message_type
5928 == dpyinfo->Xatom_editres)
5929 {
5930 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5931 if (f)
5932 _XEditResCheckMessages (f->output_data.x->widget, NULL,
5933 &event, NULL);
5934 goto done;
5935 }
5936 #endif /* HACK_EDITRES */
5937
5938 if ((event.xclient.message_type
5939 == dpyinfo->Xatom_DONE)
5940 || (event.xclient.message_type
5941 == dpyinfo->Xatom_PAGE))
5942 {
5943 /* Ghostview job completed. Kill it. We could
5944 reply with "Next" if we received "Page", but we
5945 currently never do because we are interested in
5946 images, only, which should have 1 page. */
5947 Pixmap pixmap = (Pixmap) event.xclient.data.l[1];
5948 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5949 if (!f)
5950 goto OTHER;
5951 x_kill_gs_process (pixmap, f);
5952 expose_frame (f, 0, 0, 0, 0);
5953 goto done;
5954 }
5955
5956 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5957 /* Scroll bar callbacks send a ClientMessage from which
5958 we construct an input_event. */
5959 if (event.xclient.message_type
5960 == dpyinfo->Xatom_Scrollbar)
5961 {
5962 x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (&event, &inev.ie);
5963 *finish = X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT;
5964 goto done;
5965 }
5966 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5967
5968 /* XEmbed messages from the embedder (if any). */
5969 if (event.xclient.message_type
5970 == dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED)
5971 {
5972 enum xembed_message msg = event.xclient.data.l[1];
5973 if (msg == XEMBED_FOCUS_IN || msg == XEMBED_FOCUS_OUT)
5974 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
5975
5976 *finish = X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT;
5977 goto done;
5978 }
5979
5980 xft_settings_event (dpyinfo, &event);
5981
5982 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5983 if (!f)
5984 goto OTHER;
5985 if (x_handle_dnd_message (f, &event.xclient, dpyinfo, &inev.ie))
5986 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
5987 }
5988 break;
5989
5990 case SelectionNotify:
5991 last_user_time = event.xselection.time;
5992 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
5993 if (! x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselection.requestor))
5994 goto OTHER;
5995 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
5996 x_handle_selection_notify (&event.xselection);
5997 break;
5998
5999 case SelectionClear: /* Someone has grabbed ownership. */
6000 last_user_time = event.xselectionclear.time;
6001 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6002 if (! x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselectionclear.window))
6003 goto OTHER;
6004 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6005 {
6006 XSelectionClearEvent *eventp = (XSelectionClearEvent *) &event;
6007
6008 inev.ie.kind = SELECTION_CLEAR_EVENT;
6009 SELECTION_EVENT_DISPLAY (&inev.sie) = eventp->display;
6010 SELECTION_EVENT_SELECTION (&inev.sie) = eventp->selection;
6011 SELECTION_EVENT_TIME (&inev.sie) = eventp->time;
6012 inev.ie.frame_or_window = Qnil;
6013 }
6014 break;
6015
6016 case SelectionRequest: /* Someone wants our selection. */
6017 last_user_time = event.xselectionrequest.time;
6018 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6019 if (!x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselectionrequest.owner))
6020 goto OTHER;
6021 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6022 {
6023 XSelectionRequestEvent *eventp
6024 = (XSelectionRequestEvent *) &event;
6025
6026 inev.ie.kind = SELECTION_REQUEST_EVENT;
6027 SELECTION_EVENT_DISPLAY (&inev.sie) = eventp->display;
6028 SELECTION_EVENT_REQUESTOR (&inev.sie) = eventp->requestor;
6029 SELECTION_EVENT_SELECTION (&inev.sie) = eventp->selection;
6030 SELECTION_EVENT_TARGET (&inev.sie) = eventp->target;
6031 SELECTION_EVENT_PROPERTY (&inev.sie) = eventp->property;
6032 SELECTION_EVENT_TIME (&inev.sie) = eventp->time;
6033 inev.ie.frame_or_window = Qnil;
6034 }
6035 break;
6036
6037 case PropertyNotify:
6038 last_user_time = event.xproperty.time;
6039 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xproperty.window);
6040 if (f && event.xproperty.atom == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state)
6041 x_handle_net_wm_state (f, &event.xproperty);
6042
6043 x_handle_property_notify (&event.xproperty);
6044 xft_settings_event (dpyinfo, &event);
6045 goto OTHER;
6046
6047 case ReparentNotify:
6048 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xreparent.window);
6049 if (f)
6050 {
6051 int x, y;
6052 f->output_data.x->parent_desc = event.xreparent.parent;
6053 x_real_positions (f, &x, &y);
6054 f->left_pos = x;
6055 f->top_pos = y;
6056
6057 /* Perhaps reparented due to a WM restart. Reset this. */
6058 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN;
6059 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->net_supported_window = 0;
6060 }
6061 goto OTHER;
6062
6063 case Expose:
6064 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xexpose.window);
6065 if (f)
6066 {
6067 #ifdef USE_GTK
6068 /* This seems to be needed for GTK 2.6. */
6069 x_clear_area (event.xexpose.display,
6070 event.xexpose.window,
6071 event.xexpose.x, event.xexpose.y,
6072 event.xexpose.width, event.xexpose.height,
6073 FALSE);
6074 #endif
6075 if (f->async_visible == 0)
6076 {
6077 f->async_visible = 1;
6078 f->async_iconified = 0;
6079 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
6080 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6081 }
6082 else
6083 expose_frame (f,
6084 event.xexpose.x, event.xexpose.y,
6085 event.xexpose.width, event.xexpose.height);
6086 }
6087 else
6088 {
6089 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6090 struct scroll_bar *bar;
6091 #endif
6092 #if defined USE_LUCID
6093 /* Submenus of the Lucid menu bar aren't widgets
6094 themselves, so there's no way to dispatch events
6095 to them. Recognize this case separately. */
6096 {
6097 Widget widget
6098 = x_window_to_menu_bar (event.xexpose.window);
6099 if (widget)
6100 xlwmenu_redisplay (widget);
6101 }
6102 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
6103
6104 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6105 /* Dispatch event to the widget. */
6106 goto OTHER;
6107 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6108 bar = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xexpose.display,
6109 event.xexpose.window);
6110
6111 if (bar)
6112 x_scroll_bar_expose (bar, &event);
6113 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6114 else
6115 goto OTHER;
6116 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6117 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6118 }
6119 break;
6120
6121 case GraphicsExpose: /* This occurs when an XCopyArea's
6122 source area was obscured or not
6123 available. */
6124 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xgraphicsexpose.drawable);
6125 if (f)
6126 {
6127 expose_frame (f,
6128 event.xgraphicsexpose.x, event.xgraphicsexpose.y,
6129 event.xgraphicsexpose.width,
6130 event.xgraphicsexpose.height);
6131 }
6132 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6133 else
6134 goto OTHER;
6135 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6136 break;
6137
6138 case NoExpose: /* This occurs when an XCopyArea's
6139 source area was completely
6140 available. */
6141 break;
6142
6143 case UnmapNotify:
6144 /* Redo the mouse-highlight after the tooltip has gone. */
6145 if (event.xmap.window == tip_window)
6146 {
6147 tip_window = 0;
6148 redo_mouse_highlight ();
6149 }
6150
6151 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xunmap.window);
6152 if (f) /* F may no longer exist if
6153 the frame was deleted. */
6154 {
6155 /* While a frame is unmapped, display generation is
6156 disabled; you don't want to spend time updating a
6157 display that won't ever be seen. */
6158 f->async_visible = 0;
6159 /* We can't distinguish, from the event, whether the window
6160 has become iconified or invisible. So assume, if it
6161 was previously visible, than now it is iconified.
6162 But x_make_frame_invisible clears both
6163 the visible flag and the iconified flag;
6164 and that way, we know the window is not iconified now. */
6165 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) || FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f))
6166 {
6167 f->async_iconified = 1;
6168
6169 inev.ie.kind = ICONIFY_EVENT;
6170 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6171 }
6172 }
6173 goto OTHER;
6174
6175 case MapNotify:
6176 if (event.xmap.window == tip_window)
6177 /* The tooltip has been drawn already. Avoid
6178 the SET_FRAME_GARBAGED below. */
6179 goto OTHER;
6180
6181 /* We use x_top_window_to_frame because map events can
6182 come for sub-windows and they don't mean that the
6183 frame is visible. */
6184 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xmap.window);
6185 if (f)
6186 {
6187 /* wait_reading_process_output will notice this and update
6188 the frame's display structures.
6189 If we where iconified, we should not set garbaged,
6190 because that stops redrawing on Expose events. This looks
6191 bad if we are called from a recursive event loop
6192 (x_dispatch_event), for example when a dialog is up. */
6193 if (! f->async_iconified)
6194 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6195
6196 /* Check if fullscreen was specified before we where mapped the
6197 first time, i.e. from the command line. */
6198 if (!f->output_data.x->has_been_visible)
6199 x_check_fullscreen (f);
6200
6201 f->async_visible = 1;
6202 f->async_iconified = 0;
6203 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
6204
6205 if (f->iconified)
6206 {
6207 inev.ie.kind = DEICONIFY_EVENT;
6208 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6209 }
6210 else if (! NILP (Vframe_list)
6211 && ! NILP (XCDR (Vframe_list)))
6212 /* Force a redisplay sooner or later
6213 to update the frame titles
6214 in case this is the second frame. */
6215 record_asynch_buffer_change ();
6216
6217 #ifdef USE_GTK
6218 xg_frame_resized (f, -1, -1);
6219 #endif
6220 }
6221 goto OTHER;
6222
6223 case KeyPress:
6224
6225 last_user_time = event.xkey.time;
6226 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6227
6228 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6229 /* Dispatch KeyPress events when in menu. */
6230 if (popup_activated ())
6231 goto OTHER;
6232 #endif
6233
6234 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xkey.window);
6235
6236 /* If mouse-highlight is an integer, input clears out
6237 mouse highlighting. */
6238 if (!hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden && INTEGERP (Vmouse_highlight)
6239 && (f == 0
6240 || !EQ (f->tool_bar_window, hlinfo->mouse_face_window)))
6241 {
6242 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
6243 hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 1;
6244 }
6245
6246 #if defined USE_MOTIF && defined USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6247 if (f == 0)
6248 {
6249 /* Scroll bars consume key events, but we want
6250 the keys to go to the scroll bar's frame. */
6251 Widget widget = XtWindowToWidget (dpyinfo->display,
6252 event.xkey.window);
6253 if (widget && XmIsScrollBar (widget))
6254 {
6255 widget = XtParent (widget);
6256 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, XtWindow (widget));
6257 }
6258 }
6259 #endif /* USE_MOTIF and USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6260
6261 if (f != 0)
6262 {
6263 KeySym keysym, orig_keysym;
6264 /* al%imercury@uunet.uu.net says that making this 81
6265 instead of 80 fixed a bug whereby meta chars made
6266 his Emacs hang.
6267
6268 It seems that some version of XmbLookupString has
6269 a bug of not returning XBufferOverflow in
6270 status_return even if the input is too long to
6271 fit in 81 bytes. So, we must prepare sufficient
6272 bytes for copy_buffer. 513 bytes (256 chars for
6273 two-byte character set) seems to be a fairly good
6274 approximation. -- 2000.8.10 handa@etl.go.jp */
6275 unsigned char copy_buffer[513];
6276 unsigned char *copy_bufptr = copy_buffer;
6277 int copy_bufsiz = sizeof (copy_buffer);
6278 int modifiers;
6279 Lisp_Object coding_system = Qlatin_1;
6280 Lisp_Object c;
6281
6282 #ifdef USE_GTK
6283 /* Don't pass keys to GTK. A Tab will shift focus to the
6284 tool bar in GTK 2.4. Keys will still go to menus and
6285 dialogs because in that case popup_activated is TRUE
6286 (see above). */
6287 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6288 #endif
6289
6290 event.xkey.state
6291 |= x_emacs_to_x_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
6292 extra_keyboard_modifiers);
6293 modifiers = event.xkey.state;
6294
6295 /* This will have to go some day... */
6296
6297 /* make_lispy_event turns chars into control chars.
6298 Don't do it here because XLookupString is too eager. */
6299 event.xkey.state &= ~ControlMask;
6300 event.xkey.state &= ~(dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask
6301 | dpyinfo->super_mod_mask
6302 | dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask
6303 | dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask);
6304
6305 /* In case Meta is ComposeCharacter,
6306 clear its status. According to Markus Ehrnsperger
6307 Markus.Ehrnsperger@lehrstuhl-bross.physik.uni-muenchen.de
6308 this enables ComposeCharacter to work whether or
6309 not it is combined with Meta. */
6310 if (modifiers & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
6311 memset (&compose_status, 0, sizeof (compose_status));
6312
6313 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6314 if (FRAME_XIC (f))
6315 {
6316 Status status_return;
6317
6318 coding_system = Vlocale_coding_system;
6319 nbytes = XmbLookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6320 &event.xkey, (char *) copy_bufptr,
6321 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6322 &status_return);
6323 if (status_return == XBufferOverflow)
6324 {
6325 copy_bufsiz = nbytes + 1;
6326 copy_bufptr = (unsigned char *) alloca (copy_bufsiz);
6327 nbytes = XmbLookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6328 &event.xkey, (char *) copy_bufptr,
6329 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6330 &status_return);
6331 }
6332 /* Xutf8LookupString is a new but already deprecated interface. -stef */
6333 if (status_return == XLookupNone)
6334 break;
6335 else if (status_return == XLookupChars)
6336 {
6337 keysym = NoSymbol;
6338 modifiers = 0;
6339 }
6340 else if (status_return != XLookupKeySym
6341 && status_return != XLookupBoth)
6342 abort ();
6343 }
6344 else
6345 nbytes = XLookupString (&event.xkey, (char *) copy_bufptr,
6346 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6347 &compose_status);
6348 #else
6349 nbytes = XLookupString (&event.xkey, (char *) copy_bufptr,
6350 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6351 &compose_status);
6352 #endif
6353
6354 /* If not using XIM/XIC, and a compose sequence is in progress,
6355 we break here. Otherwise, chars_matched is always 0. */
6356 if (compose_status.chars_matched > 0 && nbytes == 0)
6357 break;
6358
6359 memset (&compose_status, 0, sizeof (compose_status));
6360 orig_keysym = keysym;
6361
6362 /* Common for all keysym input events. */
6363 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6364 inev.ie.modifiers
6365 = x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f), modifiers);
6366 inev.ie.timestamp = event.xkey.time;
6367
6368 /* First deal with keysyms which have defined
6369 translations to characters. */
6370 if (keysym >= 32 && keysym < 128)
6371 /* Avoid explicitly decoding each ASCII character. */
6372 {
6373 inev.ie.kind = ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6374 inev.ie.code = keysym;
6375 goto done_keysym;
6376 }
6377
6378 /* Keysyms directly mapped to Unicode characters. */
6379 if (keysym >= 0x01000000 && keysym <= 0x0110FFFF)
6380 {
6381 if (keysym < 0x01000080)
6382 inev.ie.kind = ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6383 else
6384 inev.ie.kind = MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6385 inev.ie.code = keysym & 0xFFFFFF;
6386 goto done_keysym;
6387 }
6388
6389 /* Now non-ASCII. */
6390 if (HASH_TABLE_P (Vx_keysym_table)
6391 && (NATNUMP (c = Fgethash (make_number (keysym),
6392 Vx_keysym_table,
6393 Qnil))))
6394 {
6395 inev.ie.kind = (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (XFASTINT (c))
6396 ? ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
6397 : MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT);
6398 inev.ie.code = XFASTINT (c);
6399 goto done_keysym;
6400 }
6401
6402 /* Random non-modifier sorts of keysyms. */
6403 if (((keysym >= XK_BackSpace && keysym <= XK_Escape)
6404 || keysym == XK_Delete
6405 #ifdef XK_ISO_Left_Tab
6406 || (keysym >= XK_ISO_Left_Tab
6407 && keysym <= XK_ISO_Enter)
6408 #endif
6409 || IsCursorKey (keysym) /* 0xff50 <= x < 0xff60 */
6410 || IsMiscFunctionKey (keysym) /* 0xff60 <= x < VARIES */
6411 #ifdef HPUX
6412 /* This recognizes the "extended function
6413 keys". It seems there's no cleaner way.
6414 Test IsModifierKey to avoid handling
6415 mode_switch incorrectly. */
6416 || ((unsigned) (keysym) >= XK_Select
6417 && (unsigned)(keysym) < XK_KP_Space)
6418 #endif
6419 #ifdef XK_dead_circumflex
6420 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_circumflex
6421 #endif
6422 #ifdef XK_dead_grave
6423 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_grave
6424 #endif
6425 #ifdef XK_dead_tilde
6426 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_tilde
6427 #endif
6428 #ifdef XK_dead_diaeresis
6429 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_diaeresis
6430 #endif
6431 #ifdef XK_dead_macron
6432 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_macron
6433 #endif
6434 #ifdef XK_dead_degree
6435 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_degree
6436 #endif
6437 #ifdef XK_dead_acute
6438 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_acute
6439 #endif
6440 #ifdef XK_dead_cedilla
6441 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_cedilla
6442 #endif
6443 #ifdef XK_dead_breve
6444 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_breve
6445 #endif
6446 #ifdef XK_dead_ogonek
6447 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_ogonek
6448 #endif
6449 #ifdef XK_dead_caron
6450 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_caron
6451 #endif
6452 #ifdef XK_dead_doubleacute
6453 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_doubleacute
6454 #endif
6455 #ifdef XK_dead_abovedot
6456 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_abovedot
6457 #endif
6458 || IsKeypadKey (keysym) /* 0xff80 <= x < 0xffbe */
6459 || IsFunctionKey (keysym) /* 0xffbe <= x < 0xffe1 */
6460 /* Any "vendor-specific" key is ok. */
6461 || (orig_keysym & (1 << 28))
6462 || (keysym != NoSymbol && nbytes == 0))
6463 && ! (IsModifierKey (orig_keysym)
6464 /* The symbols from XK_ISO_Lock
6465 to XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock
6466 don't have real modifiers but
6467 should be treated similarly to
6468 Mode_switch by Emacs. */
6469 #if defined XK_ISO_Lock && defined XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock
6470 || ((unsigned)(orig_keysym)
6471 >= XK_ISO_Lock
6472 && (unsigned)(orig_keysym)
6473 <= XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock)
6474 #endif
6475 ))
6476 {
6477 STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG (keysym);
6478 /* make_lispy_event will convert this to a symbolic
6479 key. */
6480 inev.ie.kind = NON_ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6481 inev.ie.code = keysym;
6482 goto done_keysym;
6483 }
6484
6485 { /* Raw bytes, not keysym. */
6486 register int i;
6487 int nchars, len;
6488
6489 for (i = 0, nchars = 0; i < nbytes; i++)
6490 {
6491 if (ASCII_BYTE_P (copy_bufptr[i]))
6492 nchars++;
6493 STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG (copy_bufptr[i]);
6494 }
6495
6496 if (nchars < nbytes)
6497 {
6498 /* Decode the input data. */
6499 int require;
6500
6501 /* The input should be decoded with `coding_system'
6502 which depends on which X*LookupString function
6503 we used just above and the locale. */
6504 setup_coding_system (coding_system, &coding);
6505 coding.src_multibyte = 0;
6506 coding.dst_multibyte = 1;
6507 /* The input is converted to events, thus we can't
6508 handle composition. Anyway, there's no XIM that
6509 gives us composition information. */
6510 coding.common_flags &= ~CODING_ANNOTATION_MASK;
6511
6512 require = MAX_MULTIBYTE_LENGTH * nbytes;
6513 coding.destination = alloca (require);
6514 coding.dst_bytes = require;
6515 coding.mode |= CODING_MODE_LAST_BLOCK;
6516 decode_coding_c_string (&coding, copy_bufptr, nbytes, Qnil);
6517 nbytes = coding.produced;
6518 nchars = coding.produced_char;
6519 copy_bufptr = coding.destination;
6520 }
6521
6522 /* Convert the input data to a sequence of
6523 character events. */
6524 for (i = 0; i < nbytes; i += len)
6525 {
6526 int ch;
6527 if (nchars == nbytes)
6528 ch = copy_bufptr[i], len = 1;
6529 else
6530 ch = STRING_CHAR_AND_LENGTH (copy_bufptr + i, len);
6531 inev.ie.kind = (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (ch)
6532 ? ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
6533 : MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT);
6534 inev.ie.code = ch;
6535 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev.ie, hold_quit);
6536 }
6537
6538 count += nchars;
6539
6540 inev.ie.kind = NO_EVENT; /* Already stored above. */
6541
6542 if (keysym == NoSymbol)
6543 break;
6544 }
6545 }
6546 done_keysym:
6547 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6548 /* Don't dispatch this event since XtDispatchEvent calls
6549 XFilterEvent, and two calls in a row may freeze the
6550 client. */
6551 break;
6552 #else
6553 goto OTHER;
6554 #endif
6555
6556 case KeyRelease:
6557 last_user_time = event.xkey.time;
6558 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6559 /* Don't dispatch this event since XtDispatchEvent calls
6560 XFilterEvent, and two calls in a row may freeze the
6561 client. */
6562 break;
6563 #else
6564 goto OTHER;
6565 #endif
6566
6567 case EnterNotify:
6568 last_user_time = event.xcrossing.time;
6569 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6570
6571 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xcrossing.window);
6572
6573 if (f && x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position)
6574 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = event.xmotion.time + 200;
6575
6576 /* EnterNotify counts as mouse movement,
6577 so update things that depend on mouse position. */
6578 if (f && !f->output_data.x->hourglass_p)
6579 note_mouse_movement (f, &event.xmotion);
6580 #ifdef USE_GTK
6581 /* We may get an EnterNotify on the buttons in the toolbar. In that
6582 case we moved out of any highlighted area and need to note this. */
6583 if (!f && last_mouse_glyph_frame)
6584 note_mouse_movement (last_mouse_glyph_frame, &event.xmotion);
6585 #endif
6586 goto OTHER;
6587
6588 case FocusIn:
6589 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6590 goto OTHER;
6591
6592 case LeaveNotify:
6593 last_user_time = event.xcrossing.time;
6594 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6595
6596 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xcrossing.window);
6597 if (f)
6598 {
6599 if (f == hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
6600 {
6601 /* If we move outside the frame, then we're
6602 certainly no longer on any text in the frame. */
6603 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
6604 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
6605 }
6606
6607 /* Generate a nil HELP_EVENT to cancel a help-echo.
6608 Do it only if there's something to cancel.
6609 Otherwise, the startup message is cleared when
6610 the mouse leaves the frame. */
6611 if (any_help_event_p)
6612 do_help = -1;
6613 }
6614 #ifdef USE_GTK
6615 /* See comment in EnterNotify above */
6616 else if (last_mouse_glyph_frame)
6617 note_mouse_movement (last_mouse_glyph_frame, &event.xmotion);
6618 #endif
6619 goto OTHER;
6620
6621 case FocusOut:
6622 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6623 goto OTHER;
6624
6625 case MotionNotify:
6626 {
6627 last_user_time = event.xmotion.time;
6628 previous_help_echo_string = help_echo_string;
6629 help_echo_string = Qnil;
6630
6631 if (dpyinfo->grabbed && last_mouse_frame
6632 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
6633 f = last_mouse_frame;
6634 else
6635 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xmotion.window);
6636
6637 if (hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden)
6638 {
6639 hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 0;
6640 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
6641 }
6642
6643 #ifdef USE_GTK
6644 if (f && xg_event_is_for_scrollbar (f, &event))
6645 f = 0;
6646 #endif
6647 if (f)
6648 {
6649
6650 /* Generate SELECT_WINDOW_EVENTs when needed.
6651 Don't let popup menus influence things (bug#1261). */
6652 if (!NILP (Vmouse_autoselect_window) && !popup_activated ())
6653 {
6654 Lisp_Object window;
6655
6656 window = window_from_coordinates (f,
6657 event.xmotion.x, event.xmotion.y,
6658 0, 0);
6659
6660 /* Window will be selected only when it is not selected now and
6661 last mouse movement event was not in it. Minibuffer window
6662 will be selected only when it is active. */
6663 if (WINDOWP (window)
6664 && !EQ (window, last_window)
6665 && !EQ (window, selected_window)
6666 /* For click-to-focus window managers
6667 create event iff we don't leave the
6668 selected frame. */
6669 && (focus_follows_mouse
6670 || (EQ (XWINDOW (window)->frame,
6671 XWINDOW (selected_window)->frame))))
6672 {
6673 inev.ie.kind = SELECT_WINDOW_EVENT;
6674 inev.ie.frame_or_window = window;
6675 }
6676
6677 last_window=window;
6678 }
6679 if (!note_mouse_movement (f, &event.xmotion))
6680 help_echo_string = previous_help_echo_string;
6681 }
6682 else
6683 {
6684 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6685 struct scroll_bar *bar
6686 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xmotion.display,
6687 event.xmotion.window);
6688
6689 if (bar)
6690 x_scroll_bar_note_movement (bar, &event);
6691 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6692
6693 /* If we move outside the frame, then we're
6694 certainly no longer on any text in the frame. */
6695 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
6696 }
6697
6698 /* If the contents of the global variable help_echo_string
6699 has changed, generate a HELP_EVENT. */
6700 if (!NILP (help_echo_string)
6701 || !NILP (previous_help_echo_string))
6702 do_help = 1;
6703 goto OTHER;
6704 }
6705
6706 case ConfigureNotify:
6707 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xconfigure.window);
6708 #ifdef USE_GTK
6709 if (!f
6710 && (f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xconfigure.window))
6711 && event.xconfigure.window == FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
6712 {
6713 xg_frame_resized (f, event.xconfigure.width,
6714 event.xconfigure.height);
6715 f = 0;
6716 }
6717 #endif
6718 if (f)
6719 {
6720 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6721 #ifndef USE_GTK
6722 int rows = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT_TO_TEXT_LINES (f, event.xconfigure.height);
6723 int columns = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH_TO_TEXT_COLS (f, event.xconfigure.width);
6724
6725 /* In the toolkit version, change_frame_size
6726 is called by the code that handles resizing
6727 of the EmacsFrame widget. */
6728
6729 /* Even if the number of character rows and columns has
6730 not changed, the font size may have changed, so we need
6731 to check the pixel dimensions as well. */
6732 if (columns != FRAME_COLS (f)
6733 || rows != FRAME_LINES (f)
6734 || event.xconfigure.width != FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)
6735 || event.xconfigure.height != FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f))
6736 {
6737 change_frame_size (f, rows, columns, 0, 1, 0);
6738 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6739 cancel_mouse_face (f);
6740 }
6741
6742 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) = event.xconfigure.width;
6743 FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f) = event.xconfigure.height;
6744 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
6745 #endif
6746
6747 #ifdef USE_GTK
6748 /* GTK creates windows but doesn't map them.
6749 Only get real positions when mapped. */
6750 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)
6751 && gtk_widget_get_mapped (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)))
6752 #endif
6753 {
6754 x_real_positions (f, &f->left_pos, &f->top_pos);
6755 }
6756
6757 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6758 if (FRAME_XIC (f) && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMStatusArea))
6759 xic_set_statusarea (f);
6760 #endif
6761
6762 }
6763 goto OTHER;
6764
6765 case ButtonRelease:
6766 case ButtonPress:
6767 {
6768 /* If we decide we want to generate an event to be seen
6769 by the rest of Emacs, we put it here. */
6770 int tool_bar_p = 0;
6771
6772 memset (&compose_status, 0, sizeof (compose_status));
6773 last_mouse_glyph_frame = 0;
6774 last_user_time = event.xbutton.time;
6775
6776 if (dpyinfo->grabbed
6777 && last_mouse_frame
6778 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
6779 f = last_mouse_frame;
6780 else
6781 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xbutton.window);
6782
6783 #ifdef USE_GTK
6784 if (f && xg_event_is_for_scrollbar (f, &event))
6785 f = 0;
6786 #endif
6787 if (f)
6788 {
6789 /* Is this in the tool-bar? */
6790 if (WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window)
6791 && WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window)))
6792 {
6793 Lisp_Object window;
6794 int x = event.xbutton.x;
6795 int y = event.xbutton.y;
6796
6797 window = window_from_coordinates (f, x, y, 0, 1);
6798 tool_bar_p = EQ (window, f->tool_bar_window);
6799
6800 if (tool_bar_p && event.xbutton.button < 4)
6801 {
6802 handle_tool_bar_click (f, x, y,
6803 event.xbutton.type == ButtonPress,
6804 x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (dpyinfo,
6805 event.xbutton.state));
6806 }
6807 }
6808
6809 if (!tool_bar_p)
6810 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6811 if (! popup_activated ())
6812 #endif
6813 {
6814 if (ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout)
6815 {
6816 if (event.type == ButtonPress
6817 && (int)(event.xbutton.time - ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout) > 0)
6818 {
6819 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6820 construct_mouse_click (&inev.ie, &event.xbutton, f);
6821 }
6822 if (event.type == ButtonRelease)
6823 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6824 }
6825 else
6826 construct_mouse_click (&inev.ie, &event.xbutton, f);
6827 }
6828 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
6829 xembed_send_message (f, event.xbutton.time,
6830 XEMBED_REQUEST_FOCUS, 0, 0, 0);
6831 }
6832 else
6833 {
6834 struct scroll_bar *bar
6835 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xbutton.display,
6836 event.xbutton.window);
6837
6838 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6839 /* Make the "Ctrl-Mouse-2 splits window" work for toolkit
6840 scroll bars. */
6841 if (bar && event.xbutton.state & ControlMask)
6842 {
6843 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, &event, &inev.ie);
6844 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6845 }
6846 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6847 if (bar)
6848 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, &event, &inev.ie);
6849 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6850 }
6851
6852 if (event.type == ButtonPress)
6853 {
6854 dpyinfo->grabbed |= (1 << event.xbutton.button);
6855 last_mouse_frame = f;
6856
6857 if (!tool_bar_p)
6858 last_tool_bar_item = -1;
6859 }
6860 else
6861 dpyinfo->grabbed &= ~(1 << event.xbutton.button);
6862
6863 /* Ignore any mouse motion that happened before this event;
6864 any subsequent mouse-movement Emacs events should reflect
6865 only motion after the ButtonPress/Release. */
6866 if (f != 0)
6867 f->mouse_moved = 0;
6868
6869 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6870 f = x_menubar_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, &event);
6871 /* For a down-event in the menu bar,
6872 don't pass it to Xt right now.
6873 Instead, save it away
6874 and we will pass it to Xt from kbd_buffer_get_event.
6875 That way, we can run some Lisp code first. */
6876 if (! popup_activated ()
6877 #ifdef USE_GTK
6878 /* Gtk+ menus only react to the first three buttons. */
6879 && event.xbutton.button < 3
6880 #endif
6881 && f && event.type == ButtonPress
6882 /* Verify the event is really within the menu bar
6883 and not just sent to it due to grabbing. */
6884 && event.xbutton.x >= 0
6885 && event.xbutton.x < FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)
6886 && event.xbutton.y >= 0
6887 && event.xbutton.y < f->output_data.x->menubar_height
6888 && event.xbutton.same_screen)
6889 {
6890 SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT;
6891 XSETFRAME (last_mouse_press_frame, f);
6892 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6893 }
6894 else if (event.type == ButtonPress)
6895 {
6896 last_mouse_press_frame = Qnil;
6897 goto OTHER;
6898 }
6899 else
6900 goto OTHER;
6901 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT || USE_GTK */
6902 }
6903 break;
6904
6905 case CirculateNotify:
6906 goto OTHER;
6907
6908 case CirculateRequest:
6909 goto OTHER;
6910
6911 case VisibilityNotify:
6912 goto OTHER;
6913
6914 case MappingNotify:
6915 /* Someone has changed the keyboard mapping - update the
6916 local cache. */
6917 switch (event.xmapping.request)
6918 {
6919 case MappingModifier:
6920 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo);
6921 /* This is meant to fall through. */
6922 case MappingKeyboard:
6923 XRefreshKeyboardMapping (&event.xmapping);
6924 }
6925 goto OTHER;
6926
6927 case DestroyNotify:
6928 xft_settings_event (dpyinfo, &event);
6929 break;
6930
6931 default:
6932 OTHER:
6933 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6934 BLOCK_INPUT;
6935 if (*finish != X_EVENT_DROP)
6936 XtDispatchEvent (&event);
6937 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
6938 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6939 break;
6940 }
6941
6942 done:
6943 if (inev.ie.kind != NO_EVENT)
6944 {
6945 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev.ie, hold_quit);
6946 count++;
6947 }
6948
6949 if (do_help
6950 && !(hold_quit && hold_quit->kind != NO_EVENT))
6951 {
6952 Lisp_Object frame;
6953
6954 if (f)
6955 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
6956 else
6957 frame = Qnil;
6958
6959 if (do_help > 0)
6960 {
6961 any_help_event_p = 1;
6962 gen_help_event (help_echo_string, frame, help_echo_window,
6963 help_echo_object, help_echo_pos);
6964 }
6965 else
6966 {
6967 help_echo_string = Qnil;
6968 gen_help_event (Qnil, frame, Qnil, Qnil, 0);
6969 }
6970 count++;
6971 }
6972
6973 *eventptr = event;
6974 return count;
6975 }
6976
6977
6978 /* Handles the XEvent EVENT on display DISPLAY.
6979 This is used for event loops outside the normal event handling,
6980 i.e. looping while a popup menu or a dialog is posted.
6981
6982 Returns the value handle_one_xevent sets in the finish argument. */
6983 int
6984 x_dispatch_event (XEvent *event, Display *display)
6985 {
6986 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
6987 int finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
6988
6989 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (display);
6990
6991 if (dpyinfo)
6992 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, event, &finish, 0);
6993
6994 return finish;
6995 }
6996
6997
6998 /* Read events coming from the X server.
6999 This routine is called by the SIGIO handler.
7000 We return as soon as there are no more events to be read.
7001
7002 We return the number of characters stored into the buffer,
7003 thus pretending to be `read' (except the characters we store
7004 in the keyboard buffer can be multibyte, so are not necessarily
7005 C chars).
7006
7007 EXPECTED is nonzero if the caller knows input is available. */
7008
7009 static int
7010 XTread_socket (struct terminal *terminal, int expected, struct input_event *hold_quit)
7011 {
7012 int count = 0;
7013 int event_found = 0;
7014
7015 if (interrupt_input_blocked)
7016 {
7017 interrupt_input_pending = 1;
7018 #ifdef SYNC_INPUT
7019 pending_signals = 1;
7020 #endif
7021 return -1;
7022 }
7023
7024 interrupt_input_pending = 0;
7025 #ifdef SYNC_INPUT
7026 pending_signals = pending_atimers;
7027 #endif
7028 BLOCK_INPUT;
7029
7030 /* So people can tell when we have read the available input. */
7031 input_signal_count++;
7032
7033 ++handling_signal;
7034
7035 /* For debugging, this gives a way to fake an I/O error. */
7036 if (terminal->display_info.x == XTread_socket_fake_io_error)
7037 {
7038 XTread_socket_fake_io_error = 0;
7039 x_io_error_quitter (terminal->display_info.x->display);
7040 }
7041
7042 #ifndef USE_GTK
7043 while (XPending (terminal->display_info.x->display))
7044 {
7045 int finish;
7046 XEvent event;
7047
7048 XNextEvent (terminal->display_info.x->display, &event);
7049
7050 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7051 /* Filter events for the current X input method. */
7052 if (x_filter_event (terminal->display_info.x, &event))
7053 continue;
7054 #endif
7055 event_found = 1;
7056
7057 count += handle_one_xevent (terminal->display_info.x,
7058 &event, &finish, hold_quit);
7059
7060 if (finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT)
7061 goto out;
7062 }
7063
7064 out:;
7065
7066 #else /* USE_GTK */
7067
7068 /* For GTK we must use the GTK event loop. But XEvents gets passed
7069 to our filter function above, and then to the big event switch.
7070 We use a bunch of globals to communicate with our filter function,
7071 that is kind of ugly, but it works.
7072
7073 There is no way to do one display at the time, GTK just does events
7074 from all displays. */
7075
7076 while (gtk_events_pending ())
7077 {
7078 current_count = count;
7079 current_hold_quit = hold_quit;
7080
7081 gtk_main_iteration ();
7082
7083 count = current_count;
7084 current_count = -1;
7085 current_hold_quit = 0;
7086
7087 if (current_finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT)
7088 break;
7089 }
7090 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7091
7092 /* On some systems, an X bug causes Emacs to get no more events
7093 when the window is destroyed. Detect that. (1994.) */
7094 if (! event_found)
7095 {
7096 /* Emacs and the X Server eats up CPU time if XNoOp is done every time.
7097 One XNOOP in 100 loops will make Emacs terminate.
7098 B. Bretthauer, 1994 */
7099 x_noop_count++;
7100 if (x_noop_count >= 100)
7101 {
7102 x_noop_count=0;
7103
7104 if (next_noop_dpyinfo == 0)
7105 next_noop_dpyinfo = x_display_list;
7106
7107 XNoOp (next_noop_dpyinfo->display);
7108
7109 /* Each time we get here, cycle through the displays now open. */
7110 next_noop_dpyinfo = next_noop_dpyinfo->next;
7111 }
7112 }
7113
7114 /* If the focus was just given to an auto-raising frame,
7115 raise it now. */
7116 /* ??? This ought to be able to handle more than one such frame. */
7117 if (pending_autoraise_frame)
7118 {
7119 x_raise_frame (pending_autoraise_frame);
7120 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
7121 }
7122
7123 --handling_signal;
7124 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7125
7126 return count;
7127 }
7128
7129
7130
7131 \f
7132 /***********************************************************************
7133 Text Cursor
7134 ***********************************************************************/
7135
7136 /* Set clipping for output in glyph row ROW. W is the window in which
7137 we operate. GC is the graphics context to set clipping in.
7138
7139 ROW may be a text row or, e.g., a mode line. Text rows must be
7140 clipped to the interior of the window dedicated to text display,
7141 mode lines must be clipped to the whole window. */
7142
7143 static void
7144 x_clip_to_row (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row, int area, GC gc)
7145 {
7146 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7147 XRectangle clip_rect;
7148 int window_x, window_y, window_width;
7149
7150 window_box (w, area, &window_x, &window_y, &window_width, 0);
7151
7152 clip_rect.x = window_x;
7153 clip_rect.y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (0, row->y));
7154 clip_rect.y = max (clip_rect.y, window_y);
7155 clip_rect.width = window_width;
7156 clip_rect.height = row->visible_height;
7157
7158 XSetClipRectangles (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc, 0, 0, &clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
7159 }
7160
7161
7162 /* Draw a hollow box cursor on window W in glyph row ROW. */
7163
7164 static void
7165 x_draw_hollow_cursor (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row)
7166 {
7167 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7168 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
7169 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
7170 int x, y, wd, h;
7171 XGCValues xgcv;
7172 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
7173 GC gc;
7174
7175 /* Get the glyph the cursor is on. If we can't tell because
7176 the current matrix is invalid or such, give up. */
7177 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
7178 if (cursor_glyph == NULL)
7179 return;
7180
7181 /* Compute frame-relative coordinates for phys cursor. */
7182 get_phys_cursor_geometry (w, row, cursor_glyph, &x, &y, &h);
7183 wd = w->phys_cursor_width;
7184
7185 /* The foreground of cursor_gc is typically the same as the normal
7186 background color, which can cause the cursor box to be invisible. */
7187 xgcv.foreground = f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
7188 if (dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc)
7189 XChangeGC (dpy, dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
7190 else
7191 dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc = XCreateGC (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
7192 GCForeground, &xgcv);
7193 gc = dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc;
7194
7195 /* Set clipping, draw the rectangle, and reset clipping again. */
7196 x_clip_to_row (w, row, TEXT_AREA, gc);
7197 XDrawRectangle (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc, x, y, wd, h - 1);
7198 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
7199 }
7200
7201
7202 /* Draw a bar cursor on window W in glyph row ROW.
7203
7204 Implementation note: One would like to draw a bar cursor with an
7205 angle equal to the one given by the font property XA_ITALIC_ANGLE.
7206 Unfortunately, I didn't find a font yet that has this property set.
7207 --gerd. */
7208
7209 static void
7210 x_draw_bar_cursor (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row, int width, enum text_cursor_kinds kind)
7211 {
7212 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
7213 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
7214
7215 /* If cursor is out of bounds, don't draw garbage. This can happen
7216 in mini-buffer windows when switching between echo area glyphs
7217 and mini-buffer. */
7218 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
7219 if (cursor_glyph == NULL)
7220 return;
7221
7222 /* If on an image, draw like a normal cursor. That's usually better
7223 visible than drawing a bar, esp. if the image is large so that
7224 the bar might not be in the window. */
7225 if (cursor_glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH)
7226 {
7227 struct glyph_row *r;
7228 r = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, w->phys_cursor.vpos);
7229 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, r, DRAW_CURSOR);
7230 }
7231 else
7232 {
7233 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
7234 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
7235 GC gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
7236 unsigned long mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCGraphicsExposures;
7237 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, cursor_glyph->face_id);
7238 XGCValues xgcv;
7239
7240 /* If the glyph's background equals the color we normally draw
7241 the bars cursor in, the bar cursor in its normal color is
7242 invisible. Use the glyph's foreground color instead in this
7243 case, on the assumption that the glyph's colors are chosen so
7244 that the glyph is legible. */
7245 if (face->background == f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel)
7246 xgcv.background = xgcv.foreground = face->foreground;
7247 else
7248 xgcv.background = xgcv.foreground = f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
7249 xgcv.graphics_exposures = 0;
7250
7251 if (gc)
7252 XChangeGC (dpy, gc, mask, &xgcv);
7253 else
7254 {
7255 gc = XCreateGC (dpy, window, mask, &xgcv);
7256 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->scratch_cursor_gc = gc;
7257 }
7258
7259 x_clip_to_row (w, row, TEXT_AREA, gc);
7260
7261 if (kind == BAR_CURSOR)
7262 {
7263 int x = WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x);
7264
7265 if (width < 0)
7266 width = FRAME_CURSOR_WIDTH (f);
7267 width = min (cursor_glyph->pixel_width, width);
7268
7269 w->phys_cursor_width = width;
7270
7271 /* If the character under cursor is R2L, draw the bar cursor
7272 on the right of its glyph, rather than on the left. */
7273 if ((cursor_glyph->resolved_level & 1) != 0)
7274 x += cursor_glyph->pixel_width - width;
7275
7276 XFillRectangle (dpy, window, gc, x,
7277 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->phys_cursor.y),
7278 width, row->height);
7279 }
7280 else
7281 {
7282 int dummy_x, dummy_y, dummy_h;
7283
7284 if (width < 0)
7285 width = row->height;
7286
7287 width = min (row->height, width);
7288
7289 get_phys_cursor_geometry (w, row, cursor_glyph, &dummy_x,
7290 &dummy_y, &dummy_h);
7291
7292 XFillRectangle (dpy, window, gc,
7293 WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x),
7294 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->phys_cursor.y +
7295 row->height - width),
7296 w->phys_cursor_width, width);
7297 }
7298
7299 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
7300 }
7301 }
7302
7303
7304 /* RIF: Define cursor CURSOR on frame F. */
7305
7306 static void
7307 x_define_frame_cursor (struct frame *f, Cursor cursor)
7308 {
7309 if (!f->pointer_invisible
7310 && f->output_data.x->current_cursor != cursor)
7311 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), cursor);
7312 f->output_data.x->current_cursor = cursor;
7313 }
7314
7315
7316 /* RIF: Clear area on frame F. */
7317
7318 static void
7319 x_clear_frame_area (struct frame *f, int x, int y, int width, int height)
7320 {
7321 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
7322 x, y, width, height, False);
7323 #ifdef USE_GTK
7324 /* Must queue a redraw, because scroll bars might have been cleared. */
7325 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f))
7326 gtk_widget_queue_draw (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f));
7327 #endif
7328 }
7329
7330
7331 /* RIF: Draw cursor on window W. */
7332
7333 static void
7334 x_draw_window_cursor (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *glyph_row, int x, int y, int cursor_type, int cursor_width, int on_p, int active_p)
7335 {
7336 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7337
7338 if (on_p)
7339 {
7340 w->phys_cursor_type = cursor_type;
7341 w->phys_cursor_on_p = 1;
7342
7343 if (glyph_row->exact_window_width_line_p
7344 && (glyph_row->reversed_p
7345 ? (w->phys_cursor.hpos < 0)
7346 : (w->phys_cursor.hpos >= glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA])))
7347 {
7348 glyph_row->cursor_in_fringe_p = 1;
7349 draw_fringe_bitmap (w, glyph_row, glyph_row->reversed_p);
7350 }
7351 else
7352 {
7353 switch (cursor_type)
7354 {
7355 case HOLLOW_BOX_CURSOR:
7356 x_draw_hollow_cursor (w, glyph_row);
7357 break;
7358
7359 case FILLED_BOX_CURSOR:
7360 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, glyph_row, DRAW_CURSOR);
7361 break;
7362
7363 case BAR_CURSOR:
7364 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, glyph_row, cursor_width, BAR_CURSOR);
7365 break;
7366
7367 case HBAR_CURSOR:
7368 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, glyph_row, cursor_width, HBAR_CURSOR);
7369 break;
7370
7371 case NO_CURSOR:
7372 w->phys_cursor_width = 0;
7373 break;
7374
7375 default:
7376 abort ();
7377 }
7378 }
7379
7380 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7381 if (w == XWINDOW (f->selected_window))
7382 if (FRAME_XIC (f) && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMPreeditPosition))
7383 xic_set_preeditarea (w, x, y);
7384 #endif
7385 }
7386
7387 #ifndef XFlush
7388 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
7389 #endif
7390 }
7391
7392 \f
7393 /* Icons. */
7394
7395 /* Make the x-window of frame F use the gnu icon bitmap. */
7396
7397 int
7398 x_bitmap_icon (struct frame *f, Lisp_Object file)
7399 {
7400 int bitmap_id;
7401
7402 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) == 0)
7403 return 1;
7404
7405 /* Free up our existing icon bitmap and mask if any. */
7406 if (f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap > 0)
7407 x_destroy_bitmap (f, f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap);
7408 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = 0;
7409
7410 if (STRINGP (file))
7411 {
7412 #ifdef USE_GTK
7413 /* Use gtk_window_set_icon_from_file () if available,
7414 It's not restricted to bitmaps */
7415 if (xg_set_icon (f, file))
7416 return 0;
7417 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7418 bitmap_id = x_create_bitmap_from_file (f, file);
7419 x_create_bitmap_mask (f, bitmap_id);
7420 }
7421 else
7422 {
7423 /* Create the GNU bitmap and mask if necessary. */
7424 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id < 0)
7425 {
7426 int rc = -1;
7427
7428 #ifdef USE_GTK
7429
7430 if (xg_set_icon (f, xg_default_icon_file)
7431 || xg_set_icon_from_xpm_data (f, gnu_xpm_bits))
7432 return 0;
7433
7434 #elif defined (HAVE_XPM) && defined (HAVE_X_WINDOWS)
7435
7436 rc = x_create_bitmap_from_xpm_data (f, gnu_xpm_bits);
7437 if (rc != -1)
7438 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id = rc;
7439
7440 #endif
7441
7442 /* If all else fails, use the (black and white) xbm image. */
7443 if (rc == -1)
7444 {
7445 rc = x_create_bitmap_from_data (f, (char *) gnu_xbm_bits,
7446 gnu_xbm_width, gnu_xbm_height);
7447 if (rc == -1)
7448 return 1;
7449
7450 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id = rc;
7451 x_create_bitmap_mask (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id);
7452 }
7453 }
7454
7455 /* The first time we create the GNU bitmap and mask,
7456 this increments the ref-count one extra time.
7457 As a result, the GNU bitmap and mask are never freed.
7458 That way, we don't have to worry about allocating it again. */
7459 x_reference_bitmap (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id);
7460
7461 bitmap_id = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id;
7462 }
7463
7464 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, bitmap_id);
7465 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = bitmap_id;
7466
7467 return 0;
7468 }
7469
7470
7471 /* Make the x-window of frame F use a rectangle with text.
7472 Use ICON_NAME as the text. */
7473
7474 int
7475 x_text_icon (struct frame *f, const char *icon_name)
7476 {
7477 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) == 0)
7478 return 1;
7479
7480 {
7481 XTextProperty text;
7482 text.value = (unsigned char *) icon_name;
7483 text.encoding = XA_STRING;
7484 text.format = 8;
7485 text.nitems = strlen (icon_name);
7486 XSetWMIconName (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f), &text);
7487 }
7488
7489 if (f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap > 0)
7490 x_destroy_bitmap (f, f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap);
7491 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = 0;
7492 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, 0);
7493
7494 return 0;
7495 }
7496 \f
7497 #define X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE 200
7498
7499 /* If non-nil, this should be a string.
7500 It means catch X errors and store the error message in this string.
7501
7502 The reason we use a stack is that x_catch_error/x_uncatch_error can
7503 be called from a signal handler.
7504 */
7505
7506 struct x_error_message_stack {
7507 char string[X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE];
7508 Display *dpy;
7509 struct x_error_message_stack *prev;
7510 };
7511 static struct x_error_message_stack *x_error_message;
7512
7513 /* An X error handler which stores the error message in
7514 *x_error_message. This is called from x_error_handler if
7515 x_catch_errors is in effect. */
7516
7517 static void
7518 x_error_catcher (Display *display, XErrorEvent *event)
7519 {
7520 XGetErrorText (display, event->error_code,
7521 x_error_message->string,
7522 X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE);
7523 }
7524
7525 /* Begin trapping X errors for display DPY. Actually we trap X errors
7526 for all displays, but DPY should be the display you are actually
7527 operating on.
7528
7529 After calling this function, X protocol errors no longer cause
7530 Emacs to exit; instead, they are recorded in the string
7531 stored in *x_error_message.
7532
7533 Calling x_check_errors signals an Emacs error if an X error has
7534 occurred since the last call to x_catch_errors or x_check_errors.
7535
7536 Calling x_uncatch_errors resumes the normal error handling. */
7537
7538 void x_check_errors (Display *dpy, const char *format);
7539
7540 void
7541 x_catch_errors (Display *dpy)
7542 {
7543 struct x_error_message_stack *data = xmalloc (sizeof (*data));
7544
7545 /* Make sure any errors from previous requests have been dealt with. */
7546 XSync (dpy, False);
7547
7548 data->dpy = dpy;
7549 data->string[0] = 0;
7550 data->prev = x_error_message;
7551 x_error_message = data;
7552 }
7553
7554 /* Undo the last x_catch_errors call.
7555 DPY should be the display that was passed to x_catch_errors. */
7556
7557 void
7558 x_uncatch_errors (void)
7559 {
7560 struct x_error_message_stack *tmp;
7561
7562 BLOCK_INPUT;
7563
7564 /* The display may have been closed before this function is called.
7565 Check if it is still open before calling XSync. */
7566 if (x_display_info_for_display (x_error_message->dpy) != 0)
7567 XSync (x_error_message->dpy, False);
7568
7569 tmp = x_error_message;
7570 x_error_message = x_error_message->prev;
7571 xfree (tmp);
7572 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7573 }
7574
7575 /* If any X protocol errors have arrived since the last call to
7576 x_catch_errors or x_check_errors, signal an Emacs error using
7577 sprintf (a buffer, FORMAT, the x error message text) as the text. */
7578
7579 void
7580 x_check_errors (Display *dpy, const char *format)
7581 {
7582 /* Make sure to catch any errors incurred so far. */
7583 XSync (dpy, False);
7584
7585 if (x_error_message->string[0])
7586 {
7587 char string[X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE];
7588 memcpy (string, x_error_message->string, X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE);
7589 x_uncatch_errors ();
7590 error (format, string);
7591 }
7592 }
7593
7594 /* Nonzero if we had any X protocol errors
7595 since we did x_catch_errors on DPY. */
7596
7597 int
7598 x_had_errors_p (Display *dpy)
7599 {
7600 /* Make sure to catch any errors incurred so far. */
7601 XSync (dpy, False);
7602
7603 return x_error_message->string[0] != 0;
7604 }
7605
7606 /* Forget about any errors we have had, since we did x_catch_errors on DPY. */
7607
7608 void
7609 x_clear_errors (Display *dpy)
7610 {
7611 x_error_message->string[0] = 0;
7612 }
7613
7614 #if 0 /* See comment in unwind_to_catch why calling this is a bad
7615 * idea. --lorentey */
7616 /* Close off all unclosed x_catch_errors calls. */
7617
7618 void
7619 x_fully_uncatch_errors (void)
7620 {
7621 while (x_error_message)
7622 x_uncatch_errors ();
7623 }
7624 #endif
7625
7626 /* Nonzero if x_catch_errors has been done and not yet canceled. */
7627
7628 int
7629 x_catching_errors (void)
7630 {
7631 return x_error_message != 0;
7632 }
7633
7634 #if 0
7635 static unsigned int x_wire_count;
7636 x_trace_wire (void)
7637 {
7638 fprintf (stderr, "Lib call: %d\n", ++x_wire_count);
7639 }
7640 #endif /* ! 0 */
7641
7642 \f
7643 /* Handle SIGPIPE, which can happen when the connection to a server
7644 simply goes away. SIGPIPE is handled by x_connection_signal.
7645 Don't need to do anything, because the write which caused the
7646 SIGPIPE will fail, causing Xlib to invoke the X IO error handler,
7647 which will do the appropriate cleanup for us. */
7648
7649 static SIGTYPE
7650 x_connection_signal (int signalnum) /* If we don't have an argument, */
7651 /* some compilers complain in signal calls. */
7652 {
7653 #ifdef USG
7654 /* USG systems forget handlers when they are used;
7655 must reestablish each time */
7656 signal (signalnum, x_connection_signal);
7657 #endif /* USG */
7658 }
7659
7660 \f
7661 /************************************************************************
7662 Handling X errors
7663 ************************************************************************/
7664
7665 /* Error message passed to x_connection_closed. */
7666
7667 static char *error_msg;
7668
7669 /* Handle the loss of connection to display DPY. ERROR_MESSAGE is
7670 the text of an error message that lead to the connection loss. */
7671
7672 static SIGTYPE
7673 x_connection_closed (Display *dpy, const char *error_message)
7674 {
7675 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
7676 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
7677 int idx = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
7678
7679 error_msg = (char *) alloca (strlen (error_message) + 1);
7680 strcpy (error_msg, error_message);
7681 handling_signal = 0;
7682
7683 /* Inhibit redisplay while frames are being deleted. */
7684 specbind (Qinhibit_redisplay, Qt);
7685
7686 if (dpyinfo)
7687 {
7688 /* Protect display from being closed when we delete the last
7689 frame on it. */
7690 dpyinfo->reference_count++;
7691 dpyinfo->terminal->reference_count++;
7692 }
7693
7694 /* First delete frames whose mini-buffers are on frames
7695 that are on the dead display. */
7696 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7697 {
7698 Lisp_Object minibuf_frame;
7699 minibuf_frame
7700 = WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (XFRAME (frame))));
7701 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
7702 && FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (minibuf_frame))
7703 && ! EQ (frame, minibuf_frame)
7704 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (minibuf_frame)) == dpyinfo)
7705 delete_frame (frame, Qnoelisp);
7706 }
7707
7708 /* Now delete all remaining frames on the dead display.
7709 We are now sure none of these is used as the mini-buffer
7710 for another frame that we need to delete. */
7711 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7712 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
7713 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (frame)) == dpyinfo)
7714 {
7715 /* Set this to t so that delete_frame won't get confused
7716 trying to find a replacement. */
7717 KVAR (FRAME_KBOARD (XFRAME (frame)), Vdefault_minibuffer_frame) = Qt;
7718 delete_frame (frame, Qnoelisp);
7719 }
7720
7721 /* If DPYINFO is null, this means we didn't open the display in the
7722 first place, so don't try to close it. */
7723 if (dpyinfo)
7724 {
7725 /* We can not call XtCloseDisplay here because it calls XSync.
7726 XSync inside the error handler apparently hangs Emacs. On
7727 current Xt versions, this isn't needed either. */
7728 #ifdef USE_GTK
7729 /* A long-standing GTK bug prevents proper disconnect handling
7730 (https://bugzilla.gnome.org/show_bug.cgi?id=85715). Once,
7731 the resulting Glib error message loop filled a user's disk.
7732 To avoid this, kill Emacs unconditionally on disconnect. */
7733 shut_down_emacs (0, 0, Qnil);
7734 fprintf (stderr, "%s\n\
7735 When compiled with GTK, Emacs cannot recover from X disconnects.\n\
7736 This is a GTK bug: https://bugzilla.gnome.org/show_bug.cgi?id=85715\n\
7737 For details, see etc/PROBLEMS.\n",
7738 error_msg);
7739 abort ();
7740 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7741
7742 /* Indicate that this display is dead. */
7743 dpyinfo->display = 0;
7744
7745 dpyinfo->reference_count--;
7746 dpyinfo->terminal->reference_count--;
7747 if (dpyinfo->reference_count != 0)
7748 /* We have just closed all frames on this display. */
7749 abort ();
7750
7751 {
7752 Lisp_Object tmp;
7753 XSETTERMINAL (tmp, dpyinfo->terminal);
7754 Fdelete_terminal (tmp, Qnoelisp);
7755 }
7756 }
7757
7758 if (terminal_list == 0)
7759 {
7760 fprintf (stderr, "%s\n", error_msg);
7761 Fkill_emacs (make_number (70));
7762 /* NOTREACHED */
7763 }
7764
7765 /* Ordinary stack unwind doesn't deal with these. */
7766 #ifdef SIGIO
7767 sigunblock (sigmask (SIGIO));
7768 #endif
7769 sigunblock (sigmask (SIGALRM));
7770 TOTALLY_UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7771
7772 unbind_to (idx, Qnil);
7773 clear_waiting_for_input ();
7774
7775 /* Tell GCC not to suggest attribute 'noreturn' for this function. */
7776 IF_LINT (if (! terminal_list) return; )
7777
7778 /* Here, we absolutely have to use a non-local exit (e.g. signal, throw,
7779 longjmp), because returning from this function would get us back into
7780 Xlib's code which will directly call `exit'. */
7781 error ("%s", error_msg);
7782 }
7783
7784 /* We specifically use it before defining it, so that gcc doesn't inline it,
7785 otherwise gdb doesn't know how to properly put a breakpoint on it. */
7786 static void x_error_quitter (Display *, XErrorEvent *);
7787
7788 /* This is the first-level handler for X protocol errors.
7789 It calls x_error_quitter or x_error_catcher. */
7790
7791 static int
7792 x_error_handler (Display *display, XErrorEvent *event)
7793 {
7794 if (x_error_message)
7795 x_error_catcher (display, event);
7796 else
7797 x_error_quitter (display, event);
7798 return 0;
7799 }
7800
7801 /* This is the usual handler for X protocol errors.
7802 It kills all frames on the display that we got the error for.
7803 If that was the only one, it prints an error message and kills Emacs. */
7804
7805 /* .gdbinit puts a breakpoint here, so make sure it is not inlined. */
7806
7807 /* On older GCC versions, just putting x_error_quitter
7808 after x_error_handler prevents inlining into the former. */
7809
7810 static void NO_INLINE
7811 x_error_quitter (Display *display, XErrorEvent *event)
7812 {
7813 char buf[256], buf1[356];
7814
7815 /* Ignore BadName errors. They can happen because of fonts
7816 or colors that are not defined. */
7817
7818 if (event->error_code == BadName)
7819 return;
7820
7821 /* Note that there is no real way portable across R3/R4 to get the
7822 original error handler. */
7823
7824 XGetErrorText (display, event->error_code, buf, sizeof (buf));
7825 sprintf (buf1, "X protocol error: %s on protocol request %d",
7826 buf, event->request_code);
7827 x_connection_closed (display, buf1);
7828 }
7829
7830
7831 /* This is the handler for X IO errors, always.
7832 It kills all frames on the display that we lost touch with.
7833 If that was the only one, it prints an error message and kills Emacs. */
7834
7835 static int
7836 x_io_error_quitter (Display *display)
7837 {
7838 char buf[256];
7839
7840 sprintf (buf, "Connection lost to X server `%s'", DisplayString (display));
7841 x_connection_closed (display, buf);
7842 return 0;
7843 }
7844 \f
7845 /* Changing the font of the frame. */
7846
7847 /* Give frame F the font FONT-OBJECT as its default font. The return
7848 value is FONT-OBJECT. FONTSET is an ID of the fontset for the
7849 frame. If it is negative, generate a new fontset from
7850 FONT-OBJECT. */
7851
7852 Lisp_Object
7853 x_new_font (struct frame *f, Lisp_Object font_object, int fontset)
7854 {
7855 struct font *font = XFONT_OBJECT (font_object);
7856
7857 if (fontset < 0)
7858 fontset = fontset_from_font (font_object);
7859 FRAME_FONTSET (f) = fontset;
7860 if (FRAME_FONT (f) == font)
7861 /* This font is already set in frame F. There's nothing more to
7862 do. */
7863 return font_object;
7864
7865 FRAME_FONT (f) = font;
7866 FRAME_BASELINE_OFFSET (f) = font->baseline_offset;
7867 FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f) = font->average_width;
7868 FRAME_SPACE_WIDTH (f) = font->space_width;
7869 FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) = FONT_HEIGHT (font);
7870
7871 compute_fringe_widths (f, 1);
7872
7873 /* Compute the scroll bar width in character columns. */
7874 if (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) > 0)
7875 {
7876 int wid = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
7877 FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f)
7878 = (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) + wid-1) / wid;
7879 }
7880 else
7881 {
7882 int wid = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
7883 FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) = (14 + wid - 1) / wid;
7884 }
7885
7886 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) != 0)
7887 {
7888 /* Don't change the size of a tip frame; there's no point in
7889 doing it because it's done in Fx_show_tip, and it leads to
7890 problems because the tip frame has no widget. */
7891 if (NILP (tip_frame) || XFRAME (tip_frame) != f)
7892 x_set_window_size (f, 0, FRAME_COLS (f), FRAME_LINES (f));
7893 }
7894
7895 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7896 if (FRAME_XIC (f)
7897 && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & (XIMPreeditPosition | XIMStatusArea)))
7898 {
7899 BLOCK_INPUT;
7900 xic_set_xfontset (f, SSDATA (fontset_ascii (fontset)));
7901 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7902 }
7903 #endif
7904
7905 return font_object;
7906 }
7907
7908 \f
7909 /***********************************************************************
7910 X Input Methods
7911 ***********************************************************************/
7912
7913 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7914
7915 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
7916
7917 /* XIM destroy callback function, which is called whenever the
7918 connection to input method XIM dies. CLIENT_DATA contains a
7919 pointer to the x_display_info structure corresponding to XIM. */
7920
7921 static void
7922 xim_destroy_callback (XIM xim, XPointer client_data, XPointer call_data)
7923 {
7924 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = (struct x_display_info *) client_data;
7925 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
7926
7927 BLOCK_INPUT;
7928
7929 /* No need to call XDestroyIC.. */
7930 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7931 {
7932 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
7933 if (FRAME_X_P (f) && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == dpyinfo)
7934 {
7935 FRAME_XIC (f) = NULL;
7936 xic_free_xfontset (f);
7937 }
7938 }
7939
7940 /* No need to call XCloseIM. */
7941 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
7942 XFree (dpyinfo->xim_styles);
7943 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7944 }
7945
7946 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6 */
7947
7948 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
7949 /* This isn't prototyped in OSF 5.0 or 5.1a. */
7950 extern char *XSetIMValues (XIM, ...);
7951 #endif
7952
7953 /* Open the connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO.
7954 RESOURCE_NAME is the resource name Emacs uses. */
7955
7956 static void
7957 xim_open_dpy (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, char *resource_name)
7958 {
7959 XIM xim;
7960
7961 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
7962 if (use_xim)
7963 {
7964 if (dpyinfo->xim)
7965 XCloseIM (dpyinfo->xim);
7966 xim = XOpenIM (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb, resource_name,
7967 emacs_class);
7968 dpyinfo->xim = xim;
7969
7970 if (xim)
7971 {
7972 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
7973 XIMCallback destroy;
7974 #endif
7975
7976 /* Get supported styles and XIM values. */
7977 XGetIMValues (xim, XNQueryInputStyle, &dpyinfo->xim_styles, NULL);
7978
7979 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
7980 destroy.callback = xim_destroy_callback;
7981 destroy.client_data = (XPointer)dpyinfo;
7982 XSetIMValues (xim, XNDestroyCallback, &destroy, NULL);
7983 #endif
7984 }
7985 }
7986
7987 else
7988 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
7989 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
7990 }
7991
7992
7993 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
7994
7995 /* XIM instantiate callback function, which is called whenever an XIM
7996 server is available. DISPLAY is the display of the XIM.
7997 CLIENT_DATA contains a pointer to an xim_inst_t structure created
7998 when the callback was registered. */
7999
8000 static void
8001 xim_instantiate_callback (Display *display, XPointer client_data, XPointer call_data)
8002 {
8003 struct xim_inst_t *xim_inst = (struct xim_inst_t *) client_data;
8004 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = xim_inst->dpyinfo;
8005
8006 /* We don't support multiple XIM connections. */
8007 if (dpyinfo->xim)
8008 return;
8009
8010 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, xim_inst->resource_name);
8011
8012 /* Create XIC for the existing frames on the same display, as long
8013 as they have no XIC. */
8014 if (dpyinfo->xim && dpyinfo->reference_count > 0)
8015 {
8016 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
8017
8018 BLOCK_INPUT;
8019 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
8020 {
8021 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
8022
8023 if (FRAME_X_P (f)
8024 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == xim_inst->dpyinfo)
8025 if (FRAME_XIC (f) == NULL)
8026 {
8027 create_frame_xic (f);
8028 if (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMStatusArea)
8029 xic_set_statusarea (f);
8030 if (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMPreeditPosition)
8031 {
8032 struct window *w = XWINDOW (f->selected_window);
8033 xic_set_preeditarea (w, w->cursor.x, w->cursor.y);
8034 }
8035 }
8036 }
8037
8038 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8039 }
8040 }
8041
8042 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8043
8044
8045 /* Open a connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO.
8046 RESOURCE_NAME is the resource name for Emacs. On X11R5, open the
8047 connection only at the first time. On X11R6, open the connection
8048 in the XIM instantiate callback function. */
8049
8050 static void
8051 xim_initialize (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, char *resource_name)
8052 {
8053 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8054 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
8055 if (use_xim)
8056 {
8057 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8058 struct xim_inst_t *xim_inst;
8059 int len;
8060
8061 xim_inst = (struct xim_inst_t *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct xim_inst_t));
8062 dpyinfo->xim_callback_data = xim_inst;
8063 xim_inst->dpyinfo = dpyinfo;
8064 len = strlen (resource_name);
8065 xim_inst->resource_name = (char *) xmalloc (len + 1);
8066 memcpy (xim_inst->resource_name, resource_name, len + 1);
8067 XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb,
8068 resource_name, emacs_class,
8069 xim_instantiate_callback,
8070 /* This is XPointer in XFree86
8071 but (XPointer *) on Tru64, at
8072 least, hence the configure test. */
8073 (XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback_arg6) xim_inst);
8074 #else /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8075 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, resource_name);
8076 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8077 }
8078 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8079 }
8080
8081
8082 /* Close the connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO. */
8083
8084 static void
8085 xim_close_dpy (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
8086 {
8087 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
8088 if (use_xim)
8089 {
8090 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8091 if (dpyinfo->display)
8092 XUnregisterIMInstantiateCallback (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb,
8093 NULL, emacs_class,
8094 xim_instantiate_callback, NULL);
8095 xfree (dpyinfo->xim_callback_data->resource_name);
8096 xfree (dpyinfo->xim_callback_data);
8097 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8098 if (dpyinfo->display)
8099 XCloseIM (dpyinfo->xim);
8100 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8101 XFree (dpyinfo->xim_styles);
8102 }
8103 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8104 }
8105
8106 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8107
8108
8109 \f
8110 /* Calculate the absolute position in frame F
8111 from its current recorded position values and gravity. */
8112
8113 static void
8114 x_calc_absolute_position (struct frame *f)
8115 {
8116 int flags = f->size_hint_flags;
8117
8118 /* We have nothing to do if the current position
8119 is already for the top-left corner. */
8120 if (! ((flags & XNegative) || (flags & YNegative)))
8121 return;
8122
8123 /* Treat negative positions as relative to the leftmost bottommost
8124 position that fits on the screen. */
8125 if (flags & XNegative)
8126 f->left_pos = x_display_pixel_width (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
8127 - FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) + f->left_pos;
8128
8129 {
8130 int height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8131
8132 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT && defined USE_MOTIF
8133 /* Something is fishy here. When using Motif, starting Emacs with
8134 `-g -0-0', the frame appears too low by a few pixels.
8135
8136 This seems to be so because initially, while Emacs is starting,
8137 the column widget's height and the frame's pixel height are
8138 different. The column widget's height is the right one. In
8139 later invocations, when Emacs is up, the frame's pixel height
8140 is right, though.
8141
8142 It's not obvious where the initial small difference comes from.
8143 2000-12-01, gerd. */
8144
8145 XtVaGetValues (f->output_data.x->column_widget, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
8146 #endif
8147
8148 if (flags & YNegative)
8149 f->top_pos = x_display_pixel_height (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
8150 - height + f->top_pos;
8151 }
8152
8153 /* The left_pos and top_pos
8154 are now relative to the top and left screen edges,
8155 so the flags should correspond. */
8156 f->size_hint_flags &= ~ (XNegative | YNegative);
8157 }
8158
8159 /* CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1 when calling from Fset_frame_position,
8160 to really change the position, and 0 when calling from
8161 x_make_frame_visible (in that case, XOFF and YOFF are the current
8162 position values). It is -1 when calling from x_set_frame_parameters,
8163 which means, do adjust for borders but don't change the gravity. */
8164
8165 void
8166 x_set_offset (struct frame *f, register int xoff, register int yoff, int change_gravity)
8167 {
8168 int modified_top, modified_left;
8169
8170 if (change_gravity > 0)
8171 {
8172 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->left_before_move = f->left_pos;
8173 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->top_before_move = f->top_pos;
8174
8175 f->top_pos = yoff;
8176 f->left_pos = xoff;
8177 f->size_hint_flags &= ~ (XNegative | YNegative);
8178 if (xoff < 0)
8179 f->size_hint_flags |= XNegative;
8180 if (yoff < 0)
8181 f->size_hint_flags |= YNegative;
8182 f->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
8183 }
8184 x_calc_absolute_position (f);
8185
8186 BLOCK_INPUT;
8187 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
8188
8189 modified_left = f->left_pos;
8190 modified_top = f->top_pos;
8191
8192 if (change_gravity != 0 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_A)
8193 {
8194 /* Some WMs (twm, wmaker at least) has an offset that is smaller
8195 than the WM decorations. So we use the calculated offset instead
8196 of the WM decoration sizes here (x/y_pixels_outer_diff). */
8197 modified_left += FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left;
8198 modified_top += FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top;
8199 }
8200
8201 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8202 modified_left, modified_top);
8203
8204 x_sync_with_move (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos,
8205 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN
8206 ? 1 : 0);
8207
8208 /* change_gravity is non-zero when this function is called from Lisp to
8209 programmatically move a frame. In that case, we call
8210 x_check_expected_move to discover if we have a "Type A" or "Type B"
8211 window manager, and, for a "Type A" window manager, adjust the position
8212 of the frame.
8213
8214 We call x_check_expected_move if a programmatic move occurred, and
8215 either the window manager type (A/B) is unknown or it is Type A but we
8216 need to compute the top/left offset adjustment for this frame. */
8217
8218 if (change_gravity != 0 &&
8219 (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN
8220 || (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_A
8221 && (FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left == 0
8222 && FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top == 0))))
8223 x_check_expected_move (f, modified_left, modified_top);
8224
8225 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8226 }
8227
8228 /* Return non-zero if _NET_SUPPORTING_WM_CHECK window exists and _NET_SUPPORTED
8229 on the root window for frame F contains ATOMNAME.
8230 This is how a WM check shall be done according to the Window Manager
8231 Specification/Extended Window Manager Hints at
8232 http://freedesktop.org/wiki/Specifications/wm-spec. */
8233
8234 static int
8235 wm_supports (struct frame *f, Atom want_atom)
8236 {
8237 Atom actual_type;
8238 unsigned long actual_size, bytes_remaining;
8239 int i, rc, actual_format;
8240 Window wmcheck_window;
8241 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8242 Window target_window = dpyinfo->root_window;
8243 long max_len = 65536;
8244 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
8245 unsigned char *tmp_data = NULL;
8246 Atom target_type = XA_WINDOW;
8247
8248 BLOCK_INPUT;
8249
8250 x_catch_errors (dpy);
8251 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, target_window,
8252 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_supporting_wm_check,
8253 0, max_len, False, target_type,
8254 &actual_type, &actual_format, &actual_size,
8255 &bytes_remaining, &tmp_data);
8256
8257 if (rc != Success || actual_type != XA_WINDOW || x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8258 {
8259 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8260 x_uncatch_errors ();
8261 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8262 return 0;
8263 }
8264
8265 wmcheck_window = *(Window *) tmp_data;
8266 XFree (tmp_data);
8267
8268 /* Check if window exists. */
8269 XSelectInput (dpy, wmcheck_window, StructureNotifyMask);
8270 x_sync (f);
8271 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8272 {
8273 x_uncatch_errors ();
8274 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8275 return 0;
8276 }
8277
8278 if (dpyinfo->net_supported_window != wmcheck_window)
8279 {
8280 /* Window changed, reload atoms */
8281 if (dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms != NULL)
8282 XFree (dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms);
8283 dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms = NULL;
8284 dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms = 0;
8285 dpyinfo->net_supported_window = 0;
8286
8287 target_type = XA_ATOM;
8288 tmp_data = NULL;
8289 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, target_window,
8290 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_supported,
8291 0, max_len, False, target_type,
8292 &actual_type, &actual_format, &actual_size,
8293 &bytes_remaining, &tmp_data);
8294
8295 if (rc != Success || actual_type != XA_ATOM || x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8296 {
8297 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8298 x_uncatch_errors ();
8299 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8300 return 0;
8301 }
8302
8303 dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms = (Atom *)tmp_data;
8304 dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms = actual_size;
8305 dpyinfo->net_supported_window = wmcheck_window;
8306 }
8307
8308 rc = 0;
8309
8310 for (i = 0; rc == 0 && i < dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms; ++i)
8311 rc = dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms[i] == want_atom;
8312
8313 x_uncatch_errors ();
8314 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8315
8316 return rc;
8317 }
8318
8319 static void
8320 set_wm_state (Lisp_Object frame, int add, Atom atom, Atom value)
8321 {
8322 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (frame));
8323
8324 x_send_client_event (frame, make_number (0), frame,
8325 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state,
8326 make_number (32),
8327 /* 1 = add, 0 = remove */
8328 Fcons
8329 (make_number (add ? 1 : 0),
8330 Fcons
8331 (make_fixnum_or_float (atom),
8332 value != 0
8333 ? Fcons (make_fixnum_or_float (value), Qnil)
8334 : Qnil)));
8335 }
8336
8337 void
8338 x_set_sticky (struct frame *f, Lisp_Object new_value, Lisp_Object old_value)
8339 {
8340 Lisp_Object frame;
8341 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8342
8343 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
8344
8345 set_wm_state (frame, NILP (new_value) ? 0 : 1,
8346 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_sticky, None);
8347 }
8348
8349 /* Return the current _NET_WM_STATE.
8350 SIZE_STATE is set to one of the FULLSCREEN_* values.
8351 STICKY is set to 1 if the sticky state is set, 0 if not. */
8352
8353 static void
8354 get_current_wm_state (struct frame *f,
8355 Window window,
8356 int *size_state,
8357 int *sticky)
8358 {
8359 Atom actual_type;
8360 unsigned long actual_size, bytes_remaining;
8361 int i, rc, actual_format;
8362 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8363 long max_len = 65536;
8364 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
8365 unsigned char *tmp_data = NULL;
8366 Atom target_type = XA_ATOM;
8367
8368 *sticky = 0;
8369 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_NONE;
8370
8371 BLOCK_INPUT;
8372 x_catch_errors (dpy);
8373 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, window, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state,
8374 0, max_len, False, target_type,
8375 &actual_type, &actual_format, &actual_size,
8376 &bytes_remaining, &tmp_data);
8377
8378 if (rc != Success || actual_type != target_type || x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8379 {
8380 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8381 x_uncatch_errors ();
8382 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8383 return;
8384 }
8385
8386 x_uncatch_errors ();
8387
8388 for (i = 0; i < actual_size; ++i)
8389 {
8390 Atom a = ((Atom*)tmp_data)[i];
8391 if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz)
8392 {
8393 if (*size_state == FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT)
8394 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED;
8395 else
8396 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_WIDTH;
8397 }
8398 else if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert)
8399 {
8400 if (*size_state == FULLSCREEN_WIDTH)
8401 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED;
8402 else
8403 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT;
8404 }
8405 else if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen)
8406 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_BOTH;
8407 else if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_sticky)
8408 *sticky = 1;
8409 }
8410
8411 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8412 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8413 }
8414
8415 /* Do fullscreen as specified in extended window manager hints */
8416
8417 static int
8418 do_ewmh_fullscreen (struct frame *f)
8419 {
8420 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8421 int have_net_atom = wm_supports (f, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state);
8422 int cur, dummy;
8423
8424 get_current_wm_state (f, FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f), &cur, &dummy);
8425
8426 /* Some window managers don't say they support _NET_WM_STATE, but they do say
8427 they support _NET_WM_STATE_FULLSCREEN. Try that also. */
8428 if (!have_net_atom)
8429 have_net_atom = wm_supports (f, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen);
8430
8431 if (have_net_atom && cur != f->want_fullscreen)
8432 {
8433 Lisp_Object frame;
8434
8435 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
8436
8437 /* Keep number of calls to set_wm_state as low as possible.
8438 Some window managers, or possible Gtk+, hangs when too many
8439 are sent at once. */
8440 switch (f->want_fullscreen)
8441 {
8442 case FULLSCREEN_BOTH:
8443 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_WIDTH || cur == FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED
8444 || cur == FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT)
8445 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz,
8446 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert);
8447 set_wm_state (frame, 1, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen, None);
8448 break;
8449 case FULLSCREEN_WIDTH:
8450 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_BOTH || cur == FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT
8451 || cur == FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED)
8452 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen,
8453 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert);
8454 if (cur != FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED)
8455 set_wm_state (frame, 1, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz, None);
8456 break;
8457 case FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT:
8458 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_BOTH || cur == FULLSCREEN_WIDTH
8459 || cur == FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED)
8460 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen,
8461 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz);
8462 if (cur != FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED)
8463 set_wm_state (frame, 1, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert, None);
8464 break;
8465 case FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED:
8466 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_BOTH)
8467 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen, None);
8468 set_wm_state (frame, 1, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz,
8469 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert);
8470 break;
8471 case FULLSCREEN_NONE:
8472 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_BOTH)
8473 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen, None);
8474 else
8475 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz,
8476 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert);
8477 }
8478
8479 f->want_fullscreen = FULLSCREEN_NONE;
8480
8481 }
8482
8483 return have_net_atom;
8484 }
8485
8486 static void
8487 XTfullscreen_hook (FRAME_PTR f)
8488 {
8489 if (f->async_visible)
8490 {
8491 BLOCK_INPUT;
8492 x_check_fullscreen (f);
8493 x_sync (f);
8494 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8495 }
8496 }
8497
8498
8499 static void
8500 x_handle_net_wm_state (struct frame *f, XPropertyEvent *event)
8501 {
8502 int value = FULLSCREEN_NONE;
8503 Lisp_Object lval;
8504 int sticky = 0;
8505
8506 get_current_wm_state (f, event->window, &value, &sticky);
8507 lval = Qnil;
8508 switch (value)
8509 {
8510 case FULLSCREEN_WIDTH:
8511 lval = Qfullwidth;
8512 break;
8513 case FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT:
8514 lval = Qfullheight;
8515 break;
8516 case FULLSCREEN_BOTH:
8517 lval = Qfullboth;
8518 break;
8519 case FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED:
8520 lval = Qmaximized;
8521 break;
8522 }
8523
8524 store_frame_param (f, Qfullscreen, lval);
8525 store_frame_param (f, Qsticky, sticky ? Qt : Qnil);
8526 }
8527
8528 /* Check if we need to resize the frame due to a fullscreen request.
8529 If so needed, resize the frame. */
8530 static void
8531 x_check_fullscreen (struct frame *f)
8532 {
8533 if (do_ewmh_fullscreen (f))
8534 return;
8535
8536 if (f->output_data.x->parent_desc != FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window)
8537 return; /* Only fullscreen without WM or with EWM hints (above). */
8538
8539 /* Setting fullscreen to nil doesn't do anything. We could save the
8540 last non-fullscreen size and restore it, but it seems like a
8541 lot of work for this unusual case (no window manager running). */
8542
8543 if (f->want_fullscreen != FULLSCREEN_NONE)
8544 {
8545 int width = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f), height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8546 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8547
8548 switch (f->want_fullscreen)
8549 {
8550 /* No difference between these two when there is no WM */
8551 case FULLSCREEN_BOTH:
8552 case FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED:
8553 width = x_display_pixel_width (dpyinfo);
8554 height = x_display_pixel_height (dpyinfo);
8555 break;
8556 case FULLSCREEN_WIDTH:
8557 width = x_display_pixel_width (dpyinfo);
8558 break;
8559 case FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT:
8560 height = x_display_pixel_height (dpyinfo);
8561 }
8562
8563 XResizeWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8564 width, height);
8565 }
8566 }
8567
8568 /* This function is called by x_set_offset to determine whether the window
8569 manager interfered with the positioning of the frame. Type A window
8570 managers position the surrounding window manager decorations a small
8571 amount above and left of the user-supplied position. Type B window
8572 managers position the surrounding window manager decorations at the
8573 user-specified position. If we detect a Type A window manager, we
8574 compensate by moving the window right and down by the proper amount. */
8575
8576 static void
8577 x_check_expected_move (struct frame *f, int expected_left, int expected_top)
8578 {
8579 int current_left = 0, current_top = 0;
8580
8581 /* x_real_positions returns the left and top offsets of the outermost
8582 window manager window around the frame. */
8583
8584 x_real_positions (f, &current_left, &current_top);
8585
8586 if (current_left != expected_left || current_top != expected_top)
8587 {
8588 /* It's a "Type A" window manager. */
8589
8590 int adjusted_left;
8591 int adjusted_top;
8592
8593 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_A;
8594 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left = expected_left - current_left;
8595 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top = expected_top - current_top;
8596
8597 /* Now fix the mispositioned frame's location. */
8598
8599 adjusted_left = expected_left + FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left;
8600 adjusted_top = expected_top + FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top;
8601
8602 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8603 adjusted_left, adjusted_top);
8604
8605 x_sync_with_move (f, expected_left, expected_top, 0);
8606 }
8607 else
8608 /* It's a "Type B" window manager. We don't have to adjust the
8609 frame's position. */
8610
8611 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_B;
8612 }
8613
8614
8615 /* Wait for XGetGeometry to return up-to-date position information for a
8616 recently-moved frame. Call this immediately after calling XMoveWindow.
8617 If FUZZY is non-zero, then LEFT and TOP are just estimates of where the
8618 frame has been moved to, so we use a fuzzy position comparison instead
8619 of an exact comparison. */
8620
8621 static void
8622 x_sync_with_move (struct frame *f, int left, int top, int fuzzy)
8623 {
8624 int count = 0;
8625
8626 while (count++ < 50)
8627 {
8628 int current_left = 0, current_top = 0;
8629
8630 /* In theory, this call to XSync only needs to happen once, but in
8631 practice, it doesn't seem to work, hence the need for the surrounding
8632 loop. */
8633
8634 XSync (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), False);
8635 x_real_positions (f, &current_left, &current_top);
8636
8637 if (fuzzy)
8638 {
8639 /* The left fuzz-factor is 10 pixels. The top fuzz-factor is 40
8640 pixels. */
8641
8642 if (eabs (current_left - left) <= 10
8643 && eabs (current_top - top) <= 40)
8644 return;
8645 }
8646 else if (current_left == left && current_top == top)
8647 return;
8648 }
8649
8650 /* As a last resort, just wait 0.5 seconds and hope that XGetGeometry
8651 will then return up-to-date position info. */
8652
8653 wait_reading_process_output (0, 500000, 0, 0, Qnil, NULL, 0);
8654 }
8655
8656
8657 /* Wait for an event on frame F matching EVENTTYPE. */
8658 void
8659 x_wait_for_event (struct frame *f, int eventtype)
8660 {
8661 int level = interrupt_input_blocked;
8662
8663 SELECT_TYPE fds;
8664 EMACS_TIME tmo, tmo_at, time_now;
8665 int fd = ConnectionNumber (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8666
8667 pending_event_wait.f = f;
8668 pending_event_wait.eventtype = eventtype;
8669
8670 /* Set timeout to 0.1 second. Hopefully not noticable.
8671 Maybe it should be configurable. */
8672 EMACS_SET_SECS_USECS (tmo, 0, 100000);
8673 EMACS_GET_TIME (tmo_at);
8674 EMACS_ADD_TIME (tmo_at, tmo_at, tmo);
8675
8676 while (pending_event_wait.eventtype)
8677 {
8678 interrupt_input_pending = 1;
8679 TOTALLY_UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8680 /* XTread_socket is called after unblock. */
8681 BLOCK_INPUT;
8682 interrupt_input_blocked = level;
8683
8684 FD_ZERO (&fds);
8685 FD_SET (fd, &fds);
8686
8687 EMACS_GET_TIME (time_now);
8688 EMACS_SUB_TIME (tmo, tmo_at, time_now);
8689
8690 if (EMACS_TIME_NEG_P (tmo) || select (fd+1, &fds, NULL, NULL, &tmo) == 0)
8691 break; /* Timeout */
8692 }
8693 pending_event_wait.f = 0;
8694 pending_event_wait.eventtype = 0;
8695 }
8696
8697
8698 /* Change the size of frame F's X window to COLS/ROWS in the case F
8699 doesn't have a widget. If CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1, we change to
8700 top-left-corner window gravity for this size change and subsequent
8701 size changes. Otherwise we leave the window gravity unchanged. */
8702
8703 static void
8704 x_set_window_size_1 (struct frame *f, int change_gravity, int cols, int rows)
8705 {
8706 int pixelwidth, pixelheight;
8707
8708 check_frame_size (f, &rows, &cols);
8709 f->scroll_bar_actual_width
8710 = (!FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f)
8711 ? 0
8712 : FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f));
8713
8714 compute_fringe_widths (f, 0);
8715
8716 pixelwidth = FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, cols)
8717 + FRAME_TOOLBAR_WIDTH (f);
8718 pixelheight = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, rows)
8719 + FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f) + FRAME_TOOLBAR_HEIGHT (f);
8720
8721 if (change_gravity) f->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
8722 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
8723 XResizeWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8724 pixelwidth, pixelheight);
8725
8726
8727 /* We've set {FRAME,PIXEL}_{WIDTH,HEIGHT} to the values we hope to
8728 receive in the ConfigureNotify event; if we get what we asked
8729 for, then the event won't cause the screen to become garbaged, so
8730 we have to make sure to do it here. */
8731 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
8732
8733 /* Now, strictly speaking, we can't be sure that this is accurate,
8734 but the window manager will get around to dealing with the size
8735 change request eventually, and we'll hear how it went when the
8736 ConfigureNotify event gets here.
8737
8738 We could just not bother storing any of this information here,
8739 and let the ConfigureNotify event set everything up, but that
8740 might be kind of confusing to the Lisp code, since size changes
8741 wouldn't be reported in the frame parameters until some random
8742 point in the future when the ConfigureNotify event arrives.
8743
8744 We pass 1 for DELAY since we can't run Lisp code inside of
8745 a BLOCK_INPUT. */
8746
8747 /* But the ConfigureNotify may in fact never arrive, and then this is
8748 not right if the frame is visible. Instead wait (with timeout)
8749 for the ConfigureNotify. */
8750 if (f->async_visible)
8751 x_wait_for_event (f, ConfigureNotify);
8752 else
8753 {
8754 change_frame_size (f, rows, cols, 0, 1, 0);
8755 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) = pixelwidth;
8756 FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f) = pixelheight;
8757 x_sync (f);
8758 }
8759 }
8760
8761
8762 /* Call this to change the size of frame F's x-window.
8763 If CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1, we change to top-left-corner window gravity
8764 for this size change and subsequent size changes.
8765 Otherwise we leave the window gravity unchanged. */
8766
8767 void
8768 x_set_window_size (struct frame *f, int change_gravity, int cols, int rows)
8769 {
8770 BLOCK_INPUT;
8771
8772 if (NILP (tip_frame) || XFRAME (tip_frame) != f)
8773 {
8774 int r, c;
8775
8776 /* When the frame is maximized/fullscreen or running under for
8777 example Xmonad, x_set_window_size_1 will be a no-op.
8778 In that case, the right thing to do is extend rows/cols to
8779 the current frame size. We do that first if x_set_window_size_1
8780 turns out to not be a no-op (there is no way to know).
8781 The size will be adjusted again if the frame gets a
8782 ConfigureNotify event as a result of x_set_window_size. */
8783 int pixelh = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8784 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
8785 /* The menu bar is not part of text lines. The tool bar
8786 is however. */
8787 pixelh -= FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f);
8788 #endif
8789 r = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT_TO_TEXT_LINES (f, pixelh);
8790 /* Update f->scroll_bar_actual_width because it is used in
8791 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH_TO_TEXT_COLS. */
8792 f->scroll_bar_actual_width
8793 = FRAME_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
8794 c = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH_TO_TEXT_COLS (f, FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f));
8795 change_frame_size (f, r, c, 0, 1, 0);
8796 }
8797
8798 #ifdef USE_GTK
8799 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f))
8800 xg_frame_set_char_size (f, cols, rows);
8801 else
8802 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
8803 #else /* not USE_GTK */
8804
8805 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
8806
8807 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
8808
8809 /* If cursor was outside the new size, mark it as off. */
8810 mark_window_cursors_off (XWINDOW (f->root_window));
8811
8812 /* Clear out any recollection of where the mouse highlighting was,
8813 since it might be in a place that's outside the new frame size.
8814 Actually checking whether it is outside is a pain in the neck,
8815 so don't try--just let the highlighting be done afresh with new size. */
8816 cancel_mouse_face (f);
8817
8818 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8819 }
8820 \f
8821 /* Mouse warping. */
8822
8823 void
8824 x_set_mouse_position (struct frame *f, int x, int y)
8825 {
8826 int pix_x, pix_y;
8827
8828 pix_x = FRAME_COL_TO_PIXEL_X (f, x) + FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f) / 2;
8829 pix_y = FRAME_LINE_TO_PIXEL_Y (f, y) + FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) / 2;
8830
8831 if (pix_x < 0) pix_x = 0;
8832 if (pix_x > FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)) pix_x = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f);
8833
8834 if (pix_y < 0) pix_y = 0;
8835 if (pix_y > FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f)) pix_y = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8836
8837 BLOCK_INPUT;
8838
8839 XWarpPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), None, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8840 0, 0, 0, 0, pix_x, pix_y);
8841 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8842 }
8843
8844 /* Move the mouse to position pixel PIX_X, PIX_Y relative to frame F. */
8845
8846 void
8847 x_set_mouse_pixel_position (struct frame *f, int pix_x, int pix_y)
8848 {
8849 BLOCK_INPUT;
8850
8851 XWarpPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), None, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8852 0, 0, 0, 0, pix_x, pix_y);
8853 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8854 }
8855 \f
8856 /* Raise frame F. */
8857
8858 void
8859 x_raise_frame (struct frame *f)
8860 {
8861 BLOCK_INPUT;
8862 if (f->async_visible)
8863 XRaiseWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f));
8864
8865 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8866 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8867 }
8868
8869 /* Lower frame F. */
8870
8871 void
8872 x_lower_frame (struct frame *f)
8873 {
8874 if (f->async_visible)
8875 {
8876 BLOCK_INPUT;
8877 XLowerWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f));
8878 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8879 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8880 }
8881 }
8882
8883 /* Activate frame with Extended Window Manager Hints */
8884
8885 void
8886 x_ewmh_activate_frame (FRAME_PTR f)
8887 {
8888 /* See Window Manager Specification/Extended Window Manager Hints at
8889 http://freedesktop.org/wiki/Specifications/wm-spec */
8890
8891 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8892 if (f->async_visible && wm_supports (f, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_active_window))
8893 {
8894 Lisp_Object frame;
8895 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
8896 x_send_client_event (frame, make_number (0), frame,
8897 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_active_window,
8898 make_number (32),
8899 Fcons (make_number (1),
8900 Fcons (make_number (last_user_time),
8901 Qnil)));
8902 }
8903 }
8904
8905 static void
8906 XTframe_raise_lower (FRAME_PTR f, int raise_flag)
8907 {
8908 if (raise_flag)
8909 x_raise_frame (f);
8910 else
8911 x_lower_frame (f);
8912 }
8913 \f
8914 /* XEmbed implementation. */
8915
8916 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT || ! defined USE_GTK
8917
8918 /* XEmbed implementation. */
8919
8920 #define XEMBED_VERSION 0
8921
8922 static void
8923 xembed_set_info (struct frame *f, enum xembed_info flags)
8924 {
8925 unsigned long data[2];
8926 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8927
8928 data[0] = XEMBED_VERSION;
8929 data[1] = flags;
8930
8931 XChangeProperty (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8932 dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED_INFO, dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED_INFO,
8933 32, PropModeReplace, (unsigned char *) data, 2);
8934 }
8935 #endif /* defined USE_X_TOOLKIT || ! defined USE_GTK */
8936
8937 static void
8938 xembed_send_message (struct frame *f, Time t, enum xembed_message msg,
8939 long int detail, long int data1, long int data2)
8940 {
8941 XEvent event;
8942
8943 event.xclient.type = ClientMessage;
8944 event.xclient.window = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->parent_desc;
8945 event.xclient.message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_XEMBED;
8946 event.xclient.format = 32;
8947 event.xclient.data.l[0] = t;
8948 event.xclient.data.l[1] = msg;
8949 event.xclient.data.l[2] = detail;
8950 event.xclient.data.l[3] = data1;
8951 event.xclient.data.l[4] = data2;
8952
8953 XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->parent_desc,
8954 False, NoEventMask, &event);
8955 XSync (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), False);
8956 }
8957 \f
8958 /* Change of visibility. */
8959
8960 /* This tries to wait until the frame is really visible.
8961 However, if the window manager asks the user where to position
8962 the frame, this will return before the user finishes doing that.
8963 The frame will not actually be visible at that time,
8964 but it will become visible later when the window manager
8965 finishes with it. */
8966
8967 void
8968 x_make_frame_visible (struct frame *f)
8969 {
8970 Lisp_Object type;
8971 int original_top, original_left;
8972 int retry_count = 2;
8973
8974 retry:
8975
8976 BLOCK_INPUT;
8977
8978 type = x_icon_type (f);
8979 if (!NILP (type))
8980 x_bitmap_icon (f, type);
8981
8982 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
8983 {
8984 /* We test FRAME_GARBAGED_P here to make sure we don't
8985 call x_set_offset a second time
8986 if we get to x_make_frame_visible a second time
8987 before the window gets really visible. */
8988 if (! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
8989 && ! FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f)
8990 && ! f->output_data.x->asked_for_visible)
8991 x_set_offset (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos, 0);
8992
8993 f->output_data.x->asked_for_visible = 1;
8994
8995 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
8996 x_wm_set_window_state (f, NormalState);
8997 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
8998 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
8999 xembed_set_info (f, XEMBED_MAPPED);
9000 else
9001 {
9002 /* This was XtPopup, but that did nothing for an iconified frame. */
9003 XtMapWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
9004 }
9005 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9006 #ifdef USE_GTK
9007 gtk_widget_show_all (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
9008 gtk_window_deiconify (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)));
9009 #else
9010 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9011 xembed_set_info (f, XEMBED_MAPPED);
9012 else
9013 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9014 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
9015 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9016 }
9017
9018 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9019
9020 /* Synchronize to ensure Emacs knows the frame is visible
9021 before we do anything else. We do this loop with input not blocked
9022 so that incoming events are handled. */
9023 {
9024 Lisp_Object frame;
9025 int count;
9026 /* This must be before UNBLOCK_INPUT
9027 since events that arrive in response to the actions above
9028 will set it when they are handled. */
9029 int previously_visible = f->output_data.x->has_been_visible;
9030
9031 original_left = f->left_pos;
9032 original_top = f->top_pos;
9033
9034 /* This must come after we set COUNT. */
9035 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9036
9037 /* We unblock here so that arriving X events are processed. */
9038
9039 /* Now move the window back to where it was "supposed to be".
9040 But don't do it if the gravity is negative.
9041 When the gravity is negative, this uses a position
9042 that is 3 pixels too low. Perhaps that's really the border width.
9043
9044 Don't do this if the window has never been visible before,
9045 because the window manager may choose the position
9046 and we don't want to override it. */
9047
9048 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f)
9049 && ! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
9050 && ! FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f)
9051 && f->win_gravity == NorthWestGravity
9052 && previously_visible)
9053 {
9054 Drawable rootw;
9055 int x, y;
9056 unsigned int width, height, border, depth;
9057
9058 BLOCK_INPUT;
9059
9060 /* On some window managers (such as FVWM) moving an existing
9061 window, even to the same place, causes the window manager
9062 to introduce an offset. This can cause the window to move
9063 to an unexpected location. Check the geometry (a little
9064 slow here) and then verify that the window is in the right
9065 place. If the window is not in the right place, move it
9066 there, and take the potential window manager hit. */
9067 XGetGeometry (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
9068 &rootw, &x, &y, &width, &height, &border, &depth);
9069
9070 if (original_left != x || original_top != y)
9071 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
9072 original_left, original_top);
9073
9074 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9075 }
9076
9077 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
9078
9079 /* Wait until the frame is visible. Process X events until a
9080 MapNotify event has been seen, or until we think we won't get a
9081 MapNotify at all.. */
9082 for (count = input_signal_count + 10;
9083 input_signal_count < count && !FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f);)
9084 {
9085 /* Force processing of queued events. */
9086 x_sync (f);
9087
9088 /* Machines that do polling rather than SIGIO have been
9089 observed to go into a busy-wait here. So we'll fake an
9090 alarm signal to let the handler know that there's something
9091 to be read. We used to raise a real alarm, but it seems
9092 that the handler isn't always enabled here. This is
9093 probably a bug. */
9094 if (input_polling_used ())
9095 {
9096 /* It could be confusing if a real alarm arrives while
9097 processing the fake one. Turn it off and let the
9098 handler reset it. */
9099 int old_poll_suppress_count = poll_suppress_count;
9100 poll_suppress_count = 1;
9101 poll_for_input_1 ();
9102 poll_suppress_count = old_poll_suppress_count;
9103 }
9104
9105 /* See if a MapNotify event has been processed. */
9106 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (f);
9107 }
9108
9109 /* 2000-09-28: In
9110
9111 (let ((f (selected-frame)))
9112 (iconify-frame f)
9113 (raise-frame f))
9114
9115 the frame is not raised with various window managers on
9116 FreeBSD, GNU/Linux and Solaris. It turns out that, for some
9117 unknown reason, the call to XtMapWidget is completely ignored.
9118 Mapping the widget a second time works. */
9119
9120 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) && --retry_count > 0)
9121 goto retry;
9122 }
9123 }
9124
9125 /* Change from mapped state to withdrawn state. */
9126
9127 /* Make the frame visible (mapped and not iconified). */
9128
9129 void
9130 x_make_frame_invisible (struct frame *f)
9131 {
9132 Window window;
9133
9134 /* Use the frame's outermost window, not the one we normally draw on. */
9135 window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9136
9137 /* Don't keep the highlight on an invisible frame. */
9138 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame == f)
9139 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9140
9141 BLOCK_INPUT;
9142
9143 /* Before unmapping the window, update the WM_SIZE_HINTS property to claim
9144 that the current position of the window is user-specified, rather than
9145 program-specified, so that when the window is mapped again, it will be
9146 placed at the same location, without forcing the user to position it
9147 by hand again (they have already done that once for this window.) */
9148 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 1);
9149
9150 #ifdef USE_GTK
9151 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
9152 gtk_widget_hide (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
9153 else
9154 #else
9155 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9156 xembed_set_info (f, 0);
9157 else
9158 #endif
9159 {
9160
9161 if (! XWithdrawWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window,
9162 DefaultScreen (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f))))
9163 {
9164 UNBLOCK_INPUT_RESIGNAL;
9165 error ("Can't notify window manager of window withdrawal");
9166 }
9167 }
9168
9169 /* We can't distinguish this from iconification
9170 just by the event that we get from the server.
9171 So we can't win using the usual strategy of letting
9172 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY set this. So do it by hand,
9173 and synchronize with the server to make sure we agree. */
9174 f->visible = 0;
9175 FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f) = 0;
9176 f->async_visible = 0;
9177 f->async_iconified = 0;
9178
9179 x_sync (f);
9180
9181 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9182 }
9183
9184 /* Change window state from mapped to iconified. */
9185
9186 void
9187 x_iconify_frame (struct frame *f)
9188 {
9189 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9190 int result;
9191 #endif
9192 Lisp_Object type;
9193
9194 /* Don't keep the highlight on an invisible frame. */
9195 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame == f)
9196 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9197
9198 if (f->async_iconified)
9199 return;
9200
9201 BLOCK_INPUT;
9202
9203 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (f);
9204
9205 type = x_icon_type (f);
9206 if (!NILP (type))
9207 x_bitmap_icon (f, type);
9208
9209 #ifdef USE_GTK
9210 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
9211 {
9212 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9213 gtk_widget_show_all (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
9214
9215 gtk_window_iconify (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)));
9216 f->iconified = 1;
9217 f->visible = 1;
9218 f->async_iconified = 1;
9219 f->async_visible = 0;
9220 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9221 return;
9222 }
9223 #endif
9224
9225 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9226
9227 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9228 {
9229 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
9230 x_wm_set_window_state (f, IconicState);
9231 /* This was XtPopup, but that did nothing for an iconified frame. */
9232 XtMapWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
9233 /* The server won't give us any event to indicate
9234 that an invisible frame was changed to an icon,
9235 so we have to record it here. */
9236 f->iconified = 1;
9237 f->visible = 1;
9238 f->async_iconified = 1;
9239 f->async_visible = 0;
9240 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9241 return;
9242 }
9243
9244 result = XIconifyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
9245 XtWindow (f->output_data.x->widget),
9246 DefaultScreen (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)));
9247 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9248
9249 if (!result)
9250 error ("Can't notify window manager of iconification");
9251
9252 f->async_iconified = 1;
9253 f->async_visible = 0;
9254
9255
9256 BLOCK_INPUT;
9257 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9258 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9259 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9260
9261 /* Make sure the X server knows where the window should be positioned,
9262 in case the user deiconifies with the window manager. */
9263 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f)
9264 && ! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
9265 && ! FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9266 x_set_offset (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos, 0);
9267
9268 /* Since we don't know which revision of X we're running, we'll use both
9269 the X11R3 and X11R4 techniques. I don't know if this is a good idea. */
9270
9271 /* X11R4: send a ClientMessage to the window manager using the
9272 WM_CHANGE_STATE type. */
9273 {
9274 XEvent msg;
9275
9276 msg.xclient.window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
9277 msg.xclient.type = ClientMessage;
9278 msg.xclient.message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_wm_change_state;
9279 msg.xclient.format = 32;
9280 msg.xclient.data.l[0] = IconicState;
9281
9282 if (! XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
9283 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)),
9284 False,
9285 SubstructureRedirectMask | SubstructureNotifyMask,
9286 &msg))
9287 {
9288 UNBLOCK_INPUT_RESIGNAL;
9289 error ("Can't notify window manager of iconification");
9290 }
9291 }
9292
9293 /* X11R3: set the initial_state field of the window manager hints to
9294 IconicState. */
9295 x_wm_set_window_state (f, IconicState);
9296
9297 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9298 {
9299 /* If the frame was withdrawn, before, we must map it. */
9300 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9301 }
9302
9303 f->async_iconified = 1;
9304 f->async_visible = 0;
9305
9306 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9307 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9308 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9309 }
9310
9311 \f
9312 /* Free X resources of frame F. */
9313
9314 void
9315 x_free_frame_resources (struct frame *f)
9316 {
9317 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9318 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = &dpyinfo->mouse_highlight;
9319 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9320 Lisp_Object bar;
9321 struct scroll_bar *b;
9322 #endif
9323
9324 BLOCK_INPUT;
9325
9326 /* If a display connection is dead, don't try sending more
9327 commands to the X server. */
9328 if (dpyinfo->display)
9329 {
9330 /* We must free faces before destroying windows because some
9331 font-driver (e.g. xft) access a window while finishing a
9332 face. */
9333 if (FRAME_FACE_CACHE (f))
9334 free_frame_faces (f);
9335
9336 if (f->output_data.x->icon_desc)
9337 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->icon_desc);
9338
9339 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9340 /* Explicitly destroy the scroll bars of the frame. Without
9341 this, we get "BadDrawable" errors from the toolkit later on,
9342 presumably from expose events generated for the disappearing
9343 toolkit scroll bars. */
9344 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f); !NILP (bar); bar = b->next)
9345 {
9346 b = XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
9347 x_scroll_bar_remove (b);
9348 }
9349 #endif
9350
9351 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
9352 if (FRAME_XIC (f))
9353 free_frame_xic (f);
9354 #endif
9355
9356 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9357 if (f->output_data.x->widget)
9358 {
9359 XtDestroyWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
9360 f->output_data.x->widget = NULL;
9361 }
9362 /* Tooltips don't have widgets, only a simple X window, even if
9363 we are using a toolkit. */
9364 else if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
9365 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9366
9367 free_frame_menubar (f);
9368 #else /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9369
9370 #ifdef USE_GTK
9371 xg_free_frame_widgets (f);
9372 #endif /* USE_GTK */
9373
9374 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
9375 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9376 #endif /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9377
9378 unload_color (f, FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f));
9379 unload_color (f, FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f));
9380 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel);
9381 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->cursor_foreground_pixel);
9382 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->border_pixel);
9383 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->mouse_pixel);
9384
9385 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel != -1)
9386 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel);
9387 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
9388 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
9389 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
9390 /* Scrollbar shadow colors. */
9391 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel != -1)
9392 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel);
9393 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel != -1)
9394 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel);
9395 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
9396 if (f->output_data.x->white_relief.allocated_p)
9397 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->white_relief.pixel);
9398 if (f->output_data.x->black_relief.allocated_p)
9399 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->black_relief.pixel);
9400
9401 x_free_gcs (f);
9402 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9403 }
9404
9405 xfree (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event);
9406 xfree (f->output_data.x);
9407 f->output_data.x = NULL;
9408
9409 if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
9410 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = 0;
9411 if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame)
9412 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
9413 if (f == dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame)
9414 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9415
9416 if (f == hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
9417 {
9418 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
9419 = hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
9420 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row
9421 = hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
9422 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
9423 hlinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
9424 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
9425 }
9426
9427 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9428 }
9429
9430
9431 /* Destroy the X window of frame F. */
9432
9433 void
9434 x_destroy_window (struct frame *f)
9435 {
9436 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9437
9438 /* If a display connection is dead, don't try sending more
9439 commands to the X server. */
9440 if (dpyinfo->display != 0)
9441 x_free_frame_resources (f);
9442
9443 dpyinfo->reference_count--;
9444 }
9445
9446 \f
9447 /* Setting window manager hints. */
9448
9449 /* Set the normal size hints for the window manager, for frame F.
9450 FLAGS is the flags word to use--or 0 meaning preserve the flags
9451 that the window now has.
9452 If USER_POSITION is nonzero, we set the USPosition
9453 flag (this is useful when FLAGS is 0).
9454 The GTK version is in gtkutils.c */
9455
9456 #ifndef USE_GTK
9457 void
9458 x_wm_set_size_hint (struct frame *f, long flags, int user_position)
9459 {
9460 XSizeHints size_hints;
9461 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9462
9463 /* Setting PMaxSize caused various problems. */
9464 size_hints.flags = PResizeInc | PMinSize /* | PMaxSize */;
9465
9466 size_hints.x = f->left_pos;
9467 size_hints.y = f->top_pos;
9468
9469 size_hints.height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
9470 size_hints.width = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f);
9471
9472 size_hints.width_inc = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
9473 size_hints.height_inc = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
9474 size_hints.max_width = x_display_pixel_width (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
9475 - FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, 0);
9476 size_hints.max_height = x_display_pixel_height (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
9477 - FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, 0);
9478
9479 /* Calculate the base and minimum sizes. */
9480 {
9481 int base_width, base_height;
9482 int min_rows = 0, min_cols = 0;
9483
9484 base_width = FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, 0);
9485 base_height = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, 0);
9486
9487 check_frame_size (f, &min_rows, &min_cols);
9488
9489 /* The window manager uses the base width hints to calculate the
9490 current number of rows and columns in the frame while
9491 resizing; min_width and min_height aren't useful for this
9492 purpose, since they might not give the dimensions for a
9493 zero-row, zero-column frame.
9494
9495 We use the base_width and base_height members if we have
9496 them; otherwise, we set the min_width and min_height members
9497 to the size for a zero x zero frame. */
9498
9499 size_hints.flags |= PBaseSize;
9500 size_hints.base_width = base_width;
9501 size_hints.base_height = base_height + FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f);
9502 size_hints.min_width = base_width + min_cols * size_hints.width_inc;
9503 size_hints.min_height = base_height + min_rows * size_hints.height_inc;
9504 }
9505
9506 /* If we don't need the old flags, we don't need the old hint at all. */
9507 if (flags)
9508 {
9509 size_hints.flags |= flags;
9510 goto no_read;
9511 }
9512
9513 {
9514 XSizeHints hints; /* Sometimes I hate X Windows... */
9515 long supplied_return;
9516 int value;
9517
9518 value = XGetWMNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &hints,
9519 &supplied_return);
9520
9521 if (flags)
9522 size_hints.flags |= flags;
9523 else
9524 {
9525 if (value == 0)
9526 hints.flags = 0;
9527 if (hints.flags & PSize)
9528 size_hints.flags |= PSize;
9529 if (hints.flags & PPosition)
9530 size_hints.flags |= PPosition;
9531 if (hints.flags & USPosition)
9532 size_hints.flags |= USPosition;
9533 if (hints.flags & USSize)
9534 size_hints.flags |= USSize;
9535 }
9536 }
9537
9538 no_read:
9539
9540 #ifdef PWinGravity
9541 size_hints.win_gravity = f->win_gravity;
9542 size_hints.flags |= PWinGravity;
9543
9544 if (user_position)
9545 {
9546 size_hints.flags &= ~ PPosition;
9547 size_hints.flags |= USPosition;
9548 }
9549 #endif /* PWinGravity */
9550
9551 XSetWMNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &size_hints);
9552 }
9553 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
9554
9555 /* Used for IconicState or NormalState */
9556
9557 void
9558 x_wm_set_window_state (struct frame *f, int state)
9559 {
9560 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9561 Arg al[1];
9562
9563 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNinitialState, state);
9564 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9565 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9566 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
9567
9568 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= StateHint;
9569 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.initial_state = state;
9570
9571 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9572 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9573 }
9574
9575 void
9576 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (struct frame *f, int pixmap_id)
9577 {
9578 Pixmap icon_pixmap, icon_mask;
9579
9580 #if !defined USE_X_TOOLKIT && !defined USE_GTK
9581 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9582 #endif
9583
9584 if (pixmap_id > 0)
9585 {
9586 icon_pixmap = x_bitmap_pixmap (f, pixmap_id);
9587 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_pixmap = icon_pixmap;
9588 icon_mask = x_bitmap_mask (f, pixmap_id);
9589 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_mask = icon_mask;
9590 }
9591 else
9592 {
9593 /* It seems there is no way to turn off use of an icon
9594 pixmap. */
9595 return;
9596 }
9597
9598
9599 #ifdef USE_GTK
9600 {
9601 xg_set_frame_icon (f, icon_pixmap, icon_mask);
9602 return;
9603 }
9604
9605 #elif defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) /* same as in x_wm_set_window_state. */
9606
9607 {
9608 Arg al[1];
9609 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNiconPixmap, icon_pixmap);
9610 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9611 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNiconMask, icon_mask);
9612 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9613 }
9614
9615 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT && not USE_GTK */
9616
9617 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= (IconPixmapHint | IconMaskHint);
9618 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9619
9620 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT && not USE_GTK */
9621 }
9622
9623 void
9624 x_wm_set_icon_position (struct frame *f, int icon_x, int icon_y)
9625 {
9626 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9627
9628 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= IconPositionHint;
9629 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_x = icon_x;
9630 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_y = icon_y;
9631
9632 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9633 }
9634
9635 \f
9636 /***********************************************************************
9637 Fonts
9638 ***********************************************************************/
9639
9640 #if GLYPH_DEBUG
9641
9642 /* Check that FONT is valid on frame F. It is if it can be found in F's
9643 font table. */
9644
9645 static void
9646 x_check_font (struct frame *f, struct font *font)
9647 {
9648 Lisp_Object frame;
9649
9650 xassert (font != NULL && ! NILP (font->props[FONT_TYPE_INDEX]));
9651 if (font->driver->check)
9652 xassert (font->driver->check (f, font) == 0);
9653 }
9654
9655 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG != 0 */
9656
9657 \f
9658 /***********************************************************************
9659 Initialization
9660 ***********************************************************************/
9661
9662 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9663 static XrmOptionDescRec emacs_options[] = {
9664 {"-geometry", ".geometry", XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
9665 {"-iconic", ".iconic", XrmoptionNoArg, (XtPointer) "yes"},
9666
9667 {"-internal-border-width", "*EmacsScreen.internalBorderWidth",
9668 XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
9669 {"-ib", "*EmacsScreen.internalBorderWidth", XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
9670
9671 {"-T", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9672 {"-wn", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9673 {"-title", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9674 {"-iconname", "*EmacsShell.iconName", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9675 {"-in", "*EmacsShell.iconName", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9676 {"-mc", "*pointerColor", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9677 {"-cr", "*cursorColor", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL}
9678 };
9679
9680 /* Whether atimer for Xt timeouts is activated or not. */
9681
9682 static int x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag;
9683
9684 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9685
9686 static int x_initialized;
9687
9688 /* Test whether two display-name strings agree up to the dot that separates
9689 the screen number from the server number. */
9690 static int
9691 same_x_server (const char *name1, const char *name2)
9692 {
9693 int seen_colon = 0;
9694 const char *system_name = SSDATA (Vsystem_name);
9695 int system_name_length = strlen (system_name);
9696 int length_until_period = 0;
9697
9698 while (system_name[length_until_period] != 0
9699 && system_name[length_until_period] != '.')
9700 length_until_period++;
9701
9702 /* Treat `unix' like an empty host name. */
9703 if (! strncmp (name1, "unix:", 5))
9704 name1 += 4;
9705 if (! strncmp (name2, "unix:", 5))
9706 name2 += 4;
9707 /* Treat this host's name like an empty host name. */
9708 if (! strncmp (name1, system_name, system_name_length)
9709 && name1[system_name_length] == ':')
9710 name1 += system_name_length;
9711 if (! strncmp (name2, system_name, system_name_length)
9712 && name2[system_name_length] == ':')
9713 name2 += system_name_length;
9714 /* Treat this host's domainless name like an empty host name. */
9715 if (! strncmp (name1, system_name, length_until_period)
9716 && name1[length_until_period] == ':')
9717 name1 += length_until_period;
9718 if (! strncmp (name2, system_name, length_until_period)
9719 && name2[length_until_period] == ':')
9720 name2 += length_until_period;
9721
9722 for (; *name1 != '\0' && *name1 == *name2; name1++, name2++)
9723 {
9724 if (*name1 == ':')
9725 seen_colon++;
9726 if (seen_colon && *name1 == '.')
9727 return 1;
9728 }
9729 return (seen_colon
9730 && (*name1 == '.' || *name1 == '\0')
9731 && (*name2 == '.' || *name2 == '\0'));
9732 }
9733
9734 /* Count number of set bits in mask and number of bits to shift to
9735 get to the first bit. With MASK 0x7e0, *BITS is set to 6, and *OFFSET
9736 to 5. */
9737 static void
9738 get_bits_and_offset (long unsigned int mask, int *bits, int *offset)
9739 {
9740 int nr = 0;
9741 int off = 0;
9742
9743 while (!(mask & 1))
9744 {
9745 off++;
9746 mask >>= 1;
9747 }
9748
9749 while (mask & 1)
9750 {
9751 nr++;
9752 mask >>= 1;
9753 }
9754
9755 *offset = off;
9756 *bits = nr;
9757 }
9758
9759 /* Return 1 if display DISPLAY is available for use, 0 otherwise.
9760 But don't permanently open it, just test its availability. */
9761
9762 int
9763 x_display_ok (const char *display)
9764 {
9765 int dpy_ok = 1;
9766 Display *dpy;
9767
9768 dpy = XOpenDisplay (display);
9769 if (dpy)
9770 XCloseDisplay (dpy);
9771 else
9772 dpy_ok = 0;
9773 return dpy_ok;
9774 }
9775
9776 #ifdef USE_GTK
9777 static void
9778 my_log_handler (const gchar *log_domain, GLogLevelFlags log_level,
9779 const gchar *msg, gpointer user_data)
9780 {
9781 if (!strstr (msg, "g_set_prgname"))
9782 fprintf (stderr, "%s-WARNING **: %s\n", log_domain, msg);
9783 }
9784 #endif
9785
9786 /* Open a connection to X display DISPLAY_NAME, and return
9787 the structure that describes the open display.
9788 If we cannot contact the display, return null. */
9789
9790 struct x_display_info *
9791 x_term_init (Lisp_Object display_name, char *xrm_option, char *resource_name)
9792 {
9793 int connection;
9794 Display *dpy;
9795 struct terminal *terminal;
9796 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
9797 XrmDatabase xrdb;
9798 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo;
9799
9800 BLOCK_INPUT;
9801
9802 if (!x_initialized)
9803 {
9804 x_initialize ();
9805 ++x_initialized;
9806 }
9807
9808 if (! x_display_ok (SSDATA (display_name)))
9809 error ("Display %s can't be opened", SSDATA (display_name));
9810
9811 #ifdef USE_GTK
9812 {
9813 #define NUM_ARGV 10
9814 int argc;
9815 char *argv[NUM_ARGV];
9816 char **argv2 = argv;
9817 guint id;
9818
9819 if (x_initialized++ > 1)
9820 {
9821 xg_display_open (SSDATA (display_name), &dpy);
9822 }
9823 else
9824 {
9825 static char display_opt[] = "--display";
9826 static char name_opt[] = "--name";
9827
9828 for (argc = 0; argc < NUM_ARGV; ++argc)
9829 argv[argc] = 0;
9830
9831 argc = 0;
9832 argv[argc++] = initial_argv[0];
9833
9834 if (! NILP (display_name))
9835 {
9836 argv[argc++] = display_opt;
9837 argv[argc++] = SSDATA (display_name);
9838 }
9839
9840 argv[argc++] = name_opt;
9841 argv[argc++] = resource_name;
9842
9843 XSetLocaleModifiers ("");
9844
9845 /* Emacs can only handle core input events, so make sure
9846 Gtk doesn't use Xinput or Xinput2 extensions. */
9847 {
9848 static char fix_events[] = "GDK_CORE_DEVICE_EVENTS=1";
9849 putenv (fix_events);
9850 }
9851
9852 /* Work around GLib bug that outputs a faulty warning. See
9853 https://bugzilla.gnome.org/show_bug.cgi?id=563627. */
9854 id = g_log_set_handler ("GLib", G_LOG_LEVEL_WARNING | G_LOG_FLAG_FATAL
9855 | G_LOG_FLAG_RECURSION, my_log_handler, NULL);
9856 gtk_init (&argc, &argv2);
9857 g_log_remove_handler ("GLib", id);
9858
9859 /* gtk_init does set_locale. We must fix locale after calling it. */
9860 fixup_locale ();
9861 xg_initialize ();
9862
9863 dpy = DEFAULT_GDK_DISPLAY ();
9864
9865 /* NULL window -> events for all windows go to our function */
9866 gdk_window_add_filter (NULL, event_handler_gdk, NULL);
9867
9868 #if GTK_MAJOR_VERSION <= 2 && GTK_MINOR_VERSION <= 90
9869 /* Load our own gtkrc if it exists. */
9870 {
9871 const char *file = "~/.emacs.d/gtkrc";
9872 Lisp_Object s, abs_file;
9873
9874 s = make_string (file, strlen (file));
9875 abs_file = Fexpand_file_name (s, Qnil);
9876
9877 if (! NILP (abs_file) && !NILP (Ffile_readable_p (abs_file)))
9878 gtk_rc_parse (SSDATA (abs_file));
9879 }
9880 #endif
9881
9882 XSetErrorHandler (x_error_handler);
9883 XSetIOErrorHandler (x_io_error_quitter);
9884 }
9885 }
9886 #else /* not USE_GTK */
9887 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9888 /* weiner@footloose.sps.mot.com reports that this causes
9889 errors with X11R5:
9890 X protocol error: BadAtom (invalid Atom parameter)
9891 on protocol request 18skiloaf.
9892 So let's not use it until R6. */
9893 #ifdef HAVE_X11XTR6
9894 XtSetLanguageProc (NULL, NULL, NULL);
9895 #endif
9896
9897 {
9898 int argc = 0;
9899 char *argv[3];
9900
9901 argv[0] = "";
9902 argc = 1;
9903 if (xrm_option)
9904 {
9905 argv[argc++] = "-xrm";
9906 argv[argc++] = xrm_option;
9907 }
9908 turn_on_atimers (0);
9909 dpy = XtOpenDisplay (Xt_app_con, SSDATA (display_name),
9910 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS,
9911 emacs_options, XtNumber (emacs_options),
9912 &argc, argv);
9913 turn_on_atimers (1);
9914
9915 #ifdef HAVE_X11XTR6
9916 /* I think this is to compensate for XtSetLanguageProc. */
9917 fixup_locale ();
9918 #endif
9919 }
9920
9921 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9922 XSetLocaleModifiers ("");
9923 dpy = XOpenDisplay (SSDATA (display_name));
9924 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9925 #endif /* not USE_GTK*/
9926
9927 /* Detect failure. */
9928 if (dpy == 0)
9929 {
9930 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9931 return 0;
9932 }
9933
9934 /* We have definitely succeeded. Record the new connection. */
9935
9936 dpyinfo = (struct x_display_info *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct x_display_info));
9937 memset (dpyinfo, 0, sizeof *dpyinfo);
9938 hlinfo = &dpyinfo->mouse_highlight;
9939
9940 terminal = x_create_terminal (dpyinfo);
9941
9942 {
9943 struct x_display_info *share;
9944 Lisp_Object tail;
9945
9946 for (share = x_display_list, tail = x_display_name_list; share;
9947 share = share->next, tail = XCDR (tail))
9948 if (same_x_server (SSDATA (XCAR (XCAR (tail))),
9949 SSDATA (display_name)))
9950 break;
9951 if (share)
9952 terminal->kboard = share->terminal->kboard;
9953 else
9954 {
9955 terminal->kboard = (KBOARD *) xmalloc (sizeof (KBOARD));
9956 init_kboard (terminal->kboard);
9957 KVAR (terminal->kboard, Vwindow_system) = Qx;
9958
9959 /* Add the keyboard to the list before running Lisp code (via
9960 Qvendor_specific_keysyms below), since these are not traced
9961 via terminals but only through all_kboards. */
9962 terminal->kboard->next_kboard = all_kboards;
9963 all_kboards = terminal->kboard;
9964
9965 if (!EQ (XSYMBOL (Qvendor_specific_keysyms)->function, Qunbound))
9966 {
9967 char *vendor = ServerVendor (dpy);
9968
9969 /* Protect terminal from GC before removing it from the
9970 list of terminals. */
9971 struct gcpro gcpro1;
9972 Lisp_Object gcpro_term;
9973 XSETTERMINAL (gcpro_term, terminal);
9974 GCPRO1 (gcpro_term);
9975
9976 /* Temporarily hide the partially initialized terminal. */
9977 terminal_list = terminal->next_terminal;
9978 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9979 KVAR (terminal->kboard, Vsystem_key_alist)
9980 = call1 (Qvendor_specific_keysyms,
9981 vendor ? build_string (vendor) : empty_unibyte_string);
9982 BLOCK_INPUT;
9983 terminal->next_terminal = terminal_list;
9984 terminal_list = terminal;
9985 UNGCPRO;
9986 }
9987
9988 /* Don't let the initial kboard remain current longer than necessary.
9989 That would cause problems if a file loaded on startup tries to
9990 prompt in the mini-buffer. */
9991 if (current_kboard == initial_kboard)
9992 current_kboard = terminal->kboard;
9993 }
9994 terminal->kboard->reference_count++;
9995 }
9996
9997 /* Put this display on the chain. */
9998 dpyinfo->next = x_display_list;
9999 x_display_list = dpyinfo;
10000
10001 /* Put it on x_display_name_list as well, to keep them parallel. */
10002 x_display_name_list = Fcons (Fcons (display_name, Qnil),
10003 x_display_name_list);
10004 dpyinfo->name_list_element = XCAR (x_display_name_list);
10005
10006 dpyinfo->display = dpy;
10007
10008 /* Set the name of the terminal. */
10009 terminal->name = (char *) xmalloc (SBYTES (display_name) + 1);
10010 strncpy (terminal->name, SSDATA (display_name), SBYTES (display_name));
10011 terminal->name[SBYTES (display_name)] = 0;
10012
10013 #if 0
10014 XSetAfterFunction (x_current_display, x_trace_wire);
10015 #endif /* ! 0 */
10016
10017 dpyinfo->x_id_name
10018 = (char *) xmalloc (SBYTES (Vinvocation_name)
10019 + SBYTES (Vsystem_name)
10020 + 2);
10021 sprintf (dpyinfo->x_id_name, "%s@%s",
10022 SSDATA (Vinvocation_name), SSDATA (Vsystem_name));
10023
10024 /* Figure out which modifier bits mean what. */
10025 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo);
10026
10027 /* Get the scroll bar cursor. */
10028 #ifdef USE_GTK
10029 /* We must create a GTK cursor, it is required for GTK widgets. */
10030 dpyinfo->xg_cursor = xg_create_default_cursor (dpyinfo->display);
10031 #endif /* USE_GTK */
10032
10033 dpyinfo->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor
10034 = XCreateFontCursor (dpyinfo->display, XC_sb_v_double_arrow);
10035
10036 xrdb = x_load_resources (dpyinfo->display, xrm_option,
10037 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS);
10038 #ifdef HAVE_XRMSETDATABASE
10039 XrmSetDatabase (dpyinfo->display, xrdb);
10040 #else
10041 dpyinfo->display->db = xrdb;
10042 #endif
10043 /* Put the rdb where we can find it in a way that works on
10044 all versions. */
10045 dpyinfo->xrdb = xrdb;
10046
10047 dpyinfo->screen = ScreenOfDisplay (dpyinfo->display,
10048 DefaultScreen (dpyinfo->display));
10049 select_visual (dpyinfo);
10050 dpyinfo->cmap = DefaultColormapOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10051 dpyinfo->root_window = RootWindowOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10052 dpyinfo->client_leader_window = 0;
10053 dpyinfo->grabbed = 0;
10054 dpyinfo->reference_count = 0;
10055 dpyinfo->icon_bitmap_id = -1;
10056 dpyinfo->n_fonts = 0;
10057 dpyinfo->bitmaps = 0;
10058 dpyinfo->bitmaps_size = 0;
10059 dpyinfo->bitmaps_last = 0;
10060 dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc = 0;
10061 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
10062 hlinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
10063 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
10064 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
10065 hlinfo->mouse_face_face_id = DEFAULT_FACE_ID;
10066 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
10067 hlinfo->mouse_face_overlay = Qnil;
10068 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_x = hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_y = 0;
10069 hlinfo->mouse_face_defer = 0;
10070 hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 0;
10071 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = 0;
10072 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
10073 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
10074 dpyinfo->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN;
10075
10076 /* See if we can construct pixel values from RGB values. */
10077 dpyinfo->red_bits = dpyinfo->blue_bits = dpyinfo->green_bits = 0;
10078 dpyinfo->red_offset = dpyinfo->blue_offset = dpyinfo->green_offset = 0;
10079
10080 if (dpyinfo->visual->class == TrueColor)
10081 {
10082 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->red_mask,
10083 &dpyinfo->red_bits, &dpyinfo->red_offset);
10084 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->blue_mask,
10085 &dpyinfo->blue_bits, &dpyinfo->blue_offset);
10086 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->green_mask,
10087 &dpyinfo->green_bits, &dpyinfo->green_offset);
10088 }
10089
10090 /* See if a private colormap is requested. */
10091 if (dpyinfo->visual == DefaultVisualOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen))
10092 {
10093 if (dpyinfo->visual->class == PseudoColor)
10094 {
10095 Lisp_Object value;
10096 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10097 build_string ("privateColormap"),
10098 build_string ("PrivateColormap"),
10099 Qnil, Qnil);
10100 if (STRINGP (value)
10101 && (!strcmp (SSDATA (value), "true")
10102 || !strcmp (SSDATA (value), "on")))
10103 dpyinfo->cmap = XCopyColormapAndFree (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->cmap);
10104 }
10105 }
10106 else
10107 dpyinfo->cmap = XCreateColormap (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
10108 dpyinfo->visual, AllocNone);
10109
10110 #ifdef HAVE_XFT
10111 {
10112 /* If we are using Xft, check dpi value in X resources.
10113 It is better we use it as well, since Xft will use it, as will all
10114 Gnome applications. If our real DPI is smaller or larger than the
10115 one Xft uses, our font will look smaller or larger than other
10116 for other applications, even if it is the same font name (monospace-10
10117 for example). */
10118 char *v = XGetDefault (dpyinfo->display, "Xft", "dpi");
10119 double d;
10120 if (v != NULL && sscanf (v, "%lf", &d) == 1)
10121 dpyinfo->resy = dpyinfo->resx = d;
10122 }
10123 #endif
10124
10125 if (dpyinfo->resy < 1)
10126 {
10127 int screen_number = XScreenNumberOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10128 double pixels = DisplayHeight (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10129 double mm = DisplayHeightMM (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10130 /* Mac OS X 10.3's Xserver sometimes reports 0.0mm. */
10131 dpyinfo->resy = (mm < 1) ? 100 : pixels * 25.4 / mm;
10132 pixels = DisplayWidth (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10133 mm = DisplayWidthMM (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10134 /* Mac OS X 10.3's Xserver sometimes reports 0.0mm. */
10135 dpyinfo->resx = (mm < 1) ? 100 : pixels * 25.4 / mm;
10136 }
10137
10138 {
10139 const struct
10140 {
10141 const char *name;
10142 Atom *atom;
10143 } atom_refs[] = {
10144 { "WM_PROTOCOLS", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_protocols },
10145 { "WM_TAKE_FOCUS", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_take_focus },
10146 { "WM_SAVE_YOURSELF", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_save_yourself },
10147 { "WM_DELETE_WINDOW", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_delete_window },
10148 { "WM_CHANGE_STATE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_change_state },
10149 { "WM_CONFIGURE_DENIED", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_configure_denied },
10150 { "WM_MOVED", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_window_moved },
10151 { "WM_CLIENT_LEADER", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_client_leader },
10152 { "Editres", &dpyinfo->Xatom_editres },
10153 { "CLIPBOARD", &dpyinfo->Xatom_CLIPBOARD },
10154 { "TIMESTAMP", &dpyinfo->Xatom_TIMESTAMP },
10155 { "TEXT", &dpyinfo->Xatom_TEXT },
10156 { "COMPOUND_TEXT", &dpyinfo->Xatom_COMPOUND_TEXT },
10157 { "UTF8_STRING", &dpyinfo->Xatom_UTF8_STRING },
10158 { "DELETE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_DELETE },
10159 { "MULTIPLE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_MULTIPLE },
10160 { "INCR", &dpyinfo->Xatom_INCR },
10161 { "_EMACS_TMP_", &dpyinfo->Xatom_EMACS_TMP },
10162 { "TARGETS", &dpyinfo->Xatom_TARGETS },
10163 { "NULL", &dpyinfo->Xatom_NULL },
10164 { "ATOM_PAIR", &dpyinfo->Xatom_ATOM_PAIR },
10165 { "_XEMBED_INFO", &dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED_INFO },
10166 /* For properties of font. */
10167 { "PIXEL_SIZE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_PIXEL_SIZE },
10168 { "AVERAGE_WIDTH", &dpyinfo->Xatom_AVERAGE_WIDTH },
10169 { "_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET", &dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET },
10170 { "_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE },
10171 { "_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT", &dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT },
10172 /* Ghostscript support. */
10173 { "DONE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_DONE },
10174 { "PAGE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_PAGE },
10175 { "SCROLLBAR", &dpyinfo->Xatom_Scrollbar },
10176 { "_XEMBED", &dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED },
10177 /* EWMH */
10178 { "_NET_WM_STATE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state },
10179 { "_NET_WM_STATE_FULLSCREEN", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen },
10180 { "_NET_WM_STATE_MAXIMIZED_HORZ",
10181 &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz },
10182 { "_NET_WM_STATE_MAXIMIZED_VERT",
10183 &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert },
10184 { "_NET_WM_STATE_STICKY", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_sticky },
10185 { "_NET_WM_WINDOW_TYPE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_window_type },
10186 { "_NET_WM_WINDOW_TYPE_TOOLTIP",
10187 &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_window_type_tooltip },
10188 { "_NET_WM_ICON_NAME", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_icon_name },
10189 { "_NET_WM_NAME", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_name },
10190 { "_NET_SUPPORTED", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_supported },
10191 { "_NET_SUPPORTING_WM_CHECK", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_supporting_wm_check },
10192 { "_NET_WM_WINDOW_OPACITY", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_window_opacity },
10193 { "_NET_ACTIVE_WINDOW", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_active_window },
10194 { "_NET_FRAME_EXTENTS", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_frame_extents },
10195 /* Session management */
10196 { "SM_CLIENT_ID", &dpyinfo->Xatom_SM_CLIENT_ID },
10197 { "_XSETTINGS_SETTINGS", &dpyinfo->Xatom_xsettings_prop },
10198 { "MANAGER", &dpyinfo->Xatom_xsettings_mgr },
10199 };
10200
10201 int i;
10202 const int atom_count = sizeof (atom_refs) / sizeof (atom_refs[0]);
10203 /* 1 for _XSETTINGS_SN */
10204 const int total_atom_count = 1 + atom_count;
10205 Atom *atoms_return = xmalloc (sizeof (Atom) * total_atom_count);
10206 char **atom_names = xmalloc (sizeof (char *) * total_atom_count);
10207 char xsettings_atom_name[64];
10208
10209 for (i = 0; i < atom_count; i++)
10210 atom_names[i] = (char *) atom_refs[i].name;
10211
10212 /* Build _XSETTINGS_SN atom name */
10213 snprintf (xsettings_atom_name, sizeof (xsettings_atom_name),
10214 "_XSETTINGS_S%d", XScreenNumberOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen));
10215 atom_names[i] = xsettings_atom_name;
10216
10217 XInternAtoms (dpyinfo->display, atom_names, total_atom_count,
10218 False, atoms_return);
10219
10220 for (i = 0; i < atom_count; i++)
10221 *atom_refs[i].atom = atoms_return[i];
10222
10223 /* Manual copy of last atom */
10224 dpyinfo->Xatom_xsettings_sel = atoms_return[i];
10225
10226 xfree (atom_names);
10227 xfree (atoms_return);
10228 }
10229
10230 dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms_size = 8;
10231 dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms_length = 0;
10232 dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms = xmalloc (sizeof (*dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms)
10233 * dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms_size);
10234
10235 dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms = NULL;
10236 dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms = 0;
10237 dpyinfo->net_supported_window = 0;
10238
10239 connection = ConnectionNumber (dpyinfo->display);
10240 dpyinfo->connection = connection;
10241
10242 {
10243 dpyinfo->gray
10244 = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
10245 gray_bitmap_bits,
10246 gray_bitmap_width, gray_bitmap_height,
10247 (unsigned long) 1, (unsigned long) 0, 1);
10248 }
10249
10250 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
10251 xim_initialize (dpyinfo, resource_name);
10252 #endif
10253
10254 xsettings_initialize (dpyinfo);
10255
10256 /* This is only needed for distinguishing keyboard and process input. */
10257 if (connection != 0)
10258 add_keyboard_wait_descriptor (connection);
10259
10260 #ifdef F_SETOWN
10261 fcntl (connection, F_SETOWN, getpid ());
10262 #endif /* ! defined (F_SETOWN) */
10263
10264 #ifdef SIGIO
10265 if (interrupt_input)
10266 init_sigio (connection);
10267 #endif /* ! defined (SIGIO) */
10268
10269 #ifdef USE_LUCID
10270 {
10271 Display *dpy = dpyinfo->display;
10272 XrmValue d, fr, to;
10273 Font font;
10274
10275 d.addr = (XPointer)&dpy;
10276 d.size = sizeof (Display *);
10277 fr.addr = XtDefaultFont;
10278 fr.size = sizeof (XtDefaultFont);
10279 to.size = sizeof (Font *);
10280 to.addr = (XPointer)&font;
10281 x_catch_errors (dpy);
10282 if (!XtCallConverter (dpy, XtCvtStringToFont, &d, 1, &fr, &to, NULL))
10283 abort ();
10284 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy) || !XQueryFont (dpy, font))
10285 XrmPutLineResource (&xrdb, "Emacs.dialog.*.font: 9x15");
10286 x_uncatch_errors ();
10287 }
10288 #endif
10289
10290 /* See if we should run in synchronous mode. This is useful
10291 for debugging X code. */
10292 {
10293 Lisp_Object value;
10294 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10295 build_string ("synchronous"),
10296 build_string ("Synchronous"),
10297 Qnil, Qnil);
10298 if (STRINGP (value)
10299 && (!strcmp (SSDATA (value), "true")
10300 || !strcmp (SSDATA (value), "on")))
10301 XSynchronize (dpyinfo->display, True);
10302 }
10303
10304 {
10305 Lisp_Object value;
10306 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10307 build_string ("useXIM"),
10308 build_string ("UseXIM"),
10309 Qnil, Qnil);
10310 #ifdef USE_XIM
10311 if (STRINGP (value)
10312 && (!strcmp (SSDATA (value), "false")
10313 || !strcmp (SSDATA (value), "off")))
10314 use_xim = 0;
10315 #else
10316 if (STRINGP (value)
10317 && (!strcmp (SSDATA (value), "true")
10318 || !strcmp (SSDATA (value), "on")))
10319 use_xim = 1;
10320 #endif
10321 }
10322
10323 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
10324 /* Only do this for the very first display in the Emacs session.
10325 Ignore X session management when Emacs was first started on a
10326 tty. */
10327 if (terminal->id == 1)
10328 x_session_initialize (dpyinfo);
10329 #endif
10330
10331 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10332
10333 return dpyinfo;
10334 }
10335 \f
10336 /* Get rid of display DPYINFO, deleting all frames on it,
10337 and without sending any more commands to the X server. */
10338
10339 void
10340 x_delete_display (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
10341 {
10342 struct terminal *t;
10343
10344 /* Close all frames and delete the generic struct terminal for this
10345 X display. */
10346 for (t = terminal_list; t; t = t->next_terminal)
10347 if (t->type == output_x_window && t->display_info.x == dpyinfo)
10348 {
10349 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
10350 /* Close X session management when we close its display. */
10351 if (t->id == 1 && x_session_have_connection ())
10352 x_session_close ();
10353 #endif
10354 delete_terminal (t);
10355 break;
10356 }
10357
10358 delete_keyboard_wait_descriptor (dpyinfo->connection);
10359
10360 /* Discard this display from x_display_name_list and x_display_list.
10361 We can't use Fdelq because that can quit. */
10362 if (! NILP (x_display_name_list)
10363 && EQ (XCAR (x_display_name_list), dpyinfo->name_list_element))
10364 x_display_name_list = XCDR (x_display_name_list);
10365 else
10366 {
10367 Lisp_Object tail;
10368
10369 tail = x_display_name_list;
10370 while (CONSP (tail) && CONSP (XCDR (tail)))
10371 {
10372 if (EQ (XCAR (XCDR (tail)), dpyinfo->name_list_element))
10373 {
10374 XSETCDR (tail, XCDR (XCDR (tail)));
10375 break;
10376 }
10377 tail = XCDR (tail);
10378 }
10379 }
10380
10381 if (next_noop_dpyinfo == dpyinfo)
10382 next_noop_dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next;
10383
10384 if (x_display_list == dpyinfo)
10385 x_display_list = dpyinfo->next;
10386 else
10387 {
10388 struct x_display_info *tail;
10389
10390 for (tail = x_display_list; tail; tail = tail->next)
10391 if (tail->next == dpyinfo)
10392 tail->next = tail->next->next;
10393 }
10394
10395 xfree (dpyinfo->x_id_name);
10396 xfree (dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms);
10397 xfree (dpyinfo->color_cells);
10398 xfree (dpyinfo);
10399 }
10400
10401 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10402
10403 /* Atimer callback function for TIMER. Called every 0.1s to process
10404 Xt timeouts, if needed. We must avoid calling XtAppPending as
10405 much as possible because that function does an implicit XFlush
10406 that slows us down. */
10407
10408 static void
10409 x_process_timeouts (struct atimer *timer)
10410 {
10411 BLOCK_INPUT;
10412 x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag = 0;
10413 if (toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction || popup_activated ())
10414 {
10415 while (XtAppPending (Xt_app_con) & XtIMTimer)
10416 XtAppProcessEvent (Xt_app_con, XtIMTimer);
10417 /* Reactivate the atimer for next time. */
10418 x_activate_timeout_atimer ();
10419 }
10420 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10421 }
10422
10423 /* Install an asynchronous timer that processes Xt timeout events
10424 every 0.1s as long as either `toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction' or
10425 `popup_activated_flag' (in xmenu.c) is set. Make sure to call this
10426 function whenever these variables are set. This is necessary
10427 because some widget sets use timeouts internally, for example the
10428 LessTif menu bar, or the Xaw3d scroll bar. When Xt timeouts aren't
10429 processed, these widgets don't behave normally. */
10430
10431 void
10432 x_activate_timeout_atimer (void)
10433 {
10434 BLOCK_INPUT;
10435 if (!x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag)
10436 {
10437 EMACS_TIME interval;
10438
10439 EMACS_SET_SECS_USECS (interval, 0, 100000);
10440 start_atimer (ATIMER_RELATIVE, interval, x_process_timeouts, 0);
10441 x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag = 1;
10442 }
10443 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10444 }
10445
10446 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10447
10448 \f
10449 /* Set up use of X before we make the first connection. */
10450
10451 extern frame_parm_handler x_frame_parm_handlers[];
10452
10453 static struct redisplay_interface x_redisplay_interface =
10454 {
10455 x_frame_parm_handlers,
10456 x_produce_glyphs,
10457 x_write_glyphs,
10458 x_insert_glyphs,
10459 x_clear_end_of_line,
10460 x_scroll_run,
10461 x_after_update_window_line,
10462 x_update_window_begin,
10463 x_update_window_end,
10464 x_cursor_to,
10465 x_flush,
10466 #ifdef XFlush
10467 x_flush,
10468 #else
10469 0, /* flush_display_optional */
10470 #endif
10471 x_clear_window_mouse_face,
10472 x_get_glyph_overhangs,
10473 x_fix_overlapping_area,
10474 x_draw_fringe_bitmap,
10475 0, /* define_fringe_bitmap */
10476 0, /* destroy_fringe_bitmap */
10477 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs,
10478 x_draw_glyph_string,
10479 x_define_frame_cursor,
10480 x_clear_frame_area,
10481 x_draw_window_cursor,
10482 x_draw_vertical_window_border,
10483 x_shift_glyphs_for_insert
10484 };
10485
10486
10487 /* This function is called when the last frame on a display is deleted. */
10488 void
10489 x_delete_terminal (struct terminal *terminal)
10490 {
10491 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = terminal->display_info.x;
10492
10493 /* Protect against recursive calls. delete_frame in
10494 delete_terminal calls us back when it deletes our last frame. */
10495 if (!terminal->name)
10496 return;
10497
10498 BLOCK_INPUT;
10499 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
10500 /* We must close our connection to the XIM server before closing the
10501 X display. */
10502 if (dpyinfo->xim)
10503 xim_close_dpy (dpyinfo);
10504 #endif
10505
10506 /* If called from x_connection_closed, the display may already be closed
10507 and dpyinfo->display was set to 0 to indicate that. */
10508 if (dpyinfo->display)
10509 {
10510 x_destroy_all_bitmaps (dpyinfo);
10511 XSetCloseDownMode (dpyinfo->display, DestroyAll);
10512
10513 /* Whether or not XCloseDisplay destroys the associated resource
10514 database depends on the version of libX11. To avoid both
10515 crash and memory leak, we dissociate the database from the
10516 display and then destroy dpyinfo->xrdb ourselves.
10517
10518 Unfortunately, the above strategy does not work in some
10519 situations due to a bug in newer versions of libX11: because
10520 XrmSetDatabase doesn't clear the flag XlibDisplayDfltRMDB if
10521 dpy->db is NULL, XCloseDisplay destroys the associated
10522 database whereas it has not been created by XGetDefault
10523 (Bug#21974 in freedesktop.org Bugzilla). As a workaround, we
10524 don't destroy the database here in order to avoid the crash
10525 in the above situations for now, though that may cause memory
10526 leaks in other situations. */
10527 #if 0
10528 #ifdef HAVE_XRMSETDATABASE
10529 XrmSetDatabase (dpyinfo->display, NULL);
10530 #else
10531 dpyinfo->display->db = NULL;
10532 #endif
10533 /* We used to call XrmDestroyDatabase from x_delete_display, but
10534 some older versions of libX11 crash if we call it after
10535 closing all the displays. */
10536 XrmDestroyDatabase (dpyinfo->xrdb);
10537 #endif
10538
10539 #ifdef USE_GTK
10540 xg_display_close (dpyinfo->display);
10541 #else
10542 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10543 XtCloseDisplay (dpyinfo->display);
10544 #else
10545 XCloseDisplay (dpyinfo->display);
10546 #endif
10547 #endif /* ! USE_GTK */
10548 }
10549
10550 /* Mark as dead. */
10551 dpyinfo->display = NULL;
10552 x_delete_display (dpyinfo);
10553 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10554 }
10555
10556 /* Create a struct terminal, initialize it with the X11 specific
10557 functions and make DISPLAY->TERMINAL point to it. */
10558
10559 static struct terminal *
10560 x_create_terminal (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
10561 {
10562 struct terminal *terminal;
10563
10564 terminal = create_terminal ();
10565
10566 terminal->type = output_x_window;
10567 terminal->display_info.x = dpyinfo;
10568 dpyinfo->terminal = terminal;
10569
10570 /* kboard is initialized in x_term_init. */
10571
10572 terminal->clear_frame_hook = x_clear_frame;
10573 terminal->ins_del_lines_hook = x_ins_del_lines;
10574 terminal->delete_glyphs_hook = x_delete_glyphs;
10575 terminal->ring_bell_hook = XTring_bell;
10576 terminal->toggle_invisible_pointer_hook = XTtoggle_invisible_pointer;
10577 terminal->reset_terminal_modes_hook = XTreset_terminal_modes;
10578 terminal->set_terminal_modes_hook = XTset_terminal_modes;
10579 terminal->update_begin_hook = x_update_begin;
10580 terminal->update_end_hook = x_update_end;
10581 terminal->set_terminal_window_hook = XTset_terminal_window;
10582 terminal->read_socket_hook = XTread_socket;
10583 terminal->frame_up_to_date_hook = XTframe_up_to_date;
10584 terminal->mouse_position_hook = XTmouse_position;
10585 terminal->frame_rehighlight_hook = XTframe_rehighlight;
10586 terminal->frame_raise_lower_hook = XTframe_raise_lower;
10587 terminal->fullscreen_hook = XTfullscreen_hook;
10588 terminal->set_vertical_scroll_bar_hook = XTset_vertical_scroll_bar;
10589 terminal->condemn_scroll_bars_hook = XTcondemn_scroll_bars;
10590 terminal->redeem_scroll_bar_hook = XTredeem_scroll_bar;
10591 terminal->judge_scroll_bars_hook = XTjudge_scroll_bars;
10592
10593 terminal->delete_frame_hook = x_destroy_window;
10594 terminal->delete_terminal_hook = x_delete_terminal;
10595
10596 terminal->rif = &x_redisplay_interface;
10597 terminal->scroll_region_ok = 1; /* We'll scroll partial frames. */
10598 terminal->char_ins_del_ok = 1;
10599 terminal->line_ins_del_ok = 1; /* We'll just blt 'em. */
10600 terminal->fast_clear_end_of_line = 1; /* X does this well. */
10601 terminal->memory_below_frame = 0; /* We don't remember what scrolls
10602 off the bottom. */
10603
10604 return terminal;
10605 }
10606
10607 void
10608 x_initialize (void)
10609 {
10610 baud_rate = 19200;
10611
10612 x_noop_count = 0;
10613 last_tool_bar_item = -1;
10614 any_help_event_p = 0;
10615 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
10616
10617 #ifdef USE_GTK
10618 current_count = -1;
10619 #endif
10620
10621 /* Try to use interrupt input; if we can't, then start polling. */
10622 Fset_input_interrupt_mode (Qt);
10623
10624 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10625 XtToolkitInitialize ();
10626
10627 Xt_app_con = XtCreateApplicationContext ();
10628
10629 /* Register a converter from strings to pixels, which uses
10630 Emacs' color allocation infrastructure. */
10631 XtAppSetTypeConverter (Xt_app_con,
10632 XtRString, XtRPixel, cvt_string_to_pixel,
10633 cvt_string_to_pixel_args,
10634 XtNumber (cvt_string_to_pixel_args),
10635 XtCacheByDisplay, cvt_pixel_dtor);
10636
10637 XtAppSetFallbackResources (Xt_app_con, Xt_default_resources);
10638 #endif
10639
10640 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
10641 #ifndef USE_GTK
10642 xaw3d_arrow_scroll = False;
10643 xaw3d_pick_top = True;
10644 #endif
10645 #endif
10646
10647 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
10648 pending_event_wait.f = 0;
10649 pending_event_wait.eventtype = 0;
10650
10651 /* Note that there is no real way portable across R3/R4 to get the
10652 original error handler. */
10653 XSetErrorHandler (x_error_handler);
10654 XSetIOErrorHandler (x_io_error_quitter);
10655
10656 signal (SIGPIPE, x_connection_signal);
10657
10658 xgselect_initialize ();
10659 }
10660
10661
10662 void
10663 syms_of_xterm (void)
10664 {
10665 x_error_message = NULL;
10666
10667 staticpro (&x_display_name_list);
10668 x_display_name_list = Qnil;
10669
10670 staticpro (&last_mouse_scroll_bar);
10671 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
10672
10673 staticpro (&Qvendor_specific_keysyms);
10674 Qvendor_specific_keysyms = intern_c_string ("vendor-specific-keysyms");
10675
10676 staticpro (&Qlatin_1);
10677 Qlatin_1 = intern_c_string ("latin-1");
10678
10679 staticpro (&last_mouse_press_frame);
10680 last_mouse_press_frame = Qnil;
10681
10682 #ifdef USE_GTK
10683 xg_default_icon_file = make_pure_c_string ("icons/hicolor/scalable/apps/emacs.svg");
10684 staticpro (&xg_default_icon_file);
10685
10686 Qx_gtk_map_stock = intern_c_string ("x-gtk-map-stock");
10687 staticpro (&Qx_gtk_map_stock);
10688 #endif
10689
10690 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-use-underline-position-properties",
10691 x_use_underline_position_properties,
10692 doc: /* *Non-nil means make use of UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties.
10693 A value of nil means ignore them. If you encounter fonts with bogus
10694 UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties, for example 7x13 on XFree prior
10695 to 4.1, set this to nil. You can also use `underline-minimum-offset'
10696 to override the font's UNDERLINE_POSITION for small font display
10697 sizes. */);
10698 x_use_underline_position_properties = 1;
10699
10700 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-underline-at-descent-line",
10701 x_underline_at_descent_line,
10702 doc: /* *Non-nil means to draw the underline at the same place as the descent line.
10703 A value of nil means to draw the underline according to the value of the
10704 variable `x-use-underline-position-properties', which is usually at the
10705 baseline level. The default value is nil. */);
10706 x_underline_at_descent_line = 0;
10707
10708 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-mouse-click-focus-ignore-position",
10709 x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position,
10710 doc: /* Non-nil means that a mouse click to focus a frame does not move point.
10711 This variable is only used when the window manager requires that you
10712 click on a frame to select it (give it focus). In that case, a value
10713 of nil, means that the selected window and cursor position changes to
10714 reflect the mouse click position, while a non-nil value means that the
10715 selected window or cursor position is preserved. */);
10716 x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position = 0;
10717
10718 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-toolkit-scroll-bars", Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars,
10719 doc: /* Which toolkit scroll bars Emacs uses, if any.
10720 A value of nil means Emacs doesn't use toolkit scroll bars.
10721 With the X Window system, the value is a symbol describing the
10722 X toolkit. Possible values are: gtk, motif, xaw, or xaw3d.
10723 With MS Windows, the value is t. */);
10724 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
10725 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
10726 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("motif");
10727 #elif defined HAVE_XAW3D
10728 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("xaw3d");
10729 #elif USE_GTK
10730 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("gtk");
10731 #else
10732 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("xaw");
10733 #endif
10734 #else
10735 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = Qnil;
10736 #endif
10737
10738 staticpro (&last_mouse_motion_frame);
10739 last_mouse_motion_frame = Qnil;
10740
10741 Qmodifier_value = intern_c_string ("modifier-value");
10742 Qalt = intern_c_string ("alt");
10743 Fput (Qalt, Qmodifier_value, make_number (alt_modifier));
10744 Qhyper = intern_c_string ("hyper");
10745 Fput (Qhyper, Qmodifier_value, make_number (hyper_modifier));
10746 Qmeta = intern_c_string ("meta");
10747 Fput (Qmeta, Qmodifier_value, make_number (meta_modifier));
10748 Qsuper = intern_c_string ("super");
10749 Fput (Qsuper, Qmodifier_value, make_number (super_modifier));
10750
10751 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-alt-keysym", Vx_alt_keysym,
10752 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the alt modifier.
10753 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10754 For example, `alt' means use the Alt_L and Alt_R keysyms. The default
10755 is nil, which is the same as `alt'. */);
10756 Vx_alt_keysym = Qnil;
10757
10758 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-hyper-keysym", Vx_hyper_keysym,
10759 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the hyper modifier.
10760 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10761 For example, `hyper' means use the Hyper_L and Hyper_R keysyms. The
10762 default is nil, which is the same as `hyper'. */);
10763 Vx_hyper_keysym = Qnil;
10764
10765 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-meta-keysym", Vx_meta_keysym,
10766 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the meta modifier.
10767 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10768 For example, `meta' means use the Meta_L and Meta_R keysyms. The
10769 default is nil, which is the same as `meta'. */);
10770 Vx_meta_keysym = Qnil;
10771
10772 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-super-keysym", Vx_super_keysym,
10773 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the super modifier.
10774 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10775 For example, `super' means use the Super_L and Super_R keysyms. The
10776 default is nil, which is the same as `super'. */);
10777 Vx_super_keysym = Qnil;
10778
10779 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-keysym-table", Vx_keysym_table,
10780 doc: /* Hash table of character codes indexed by X keysym codes. */);
10781 Vx_keysym_table = make_hash_table (Qeql, make_number (900),
10782 make_float (DEFAULT_REHASH_SIZE),
10783 make_float (DEFAULT_REHASH_THRESHOLD),
10784 Qnil, Qnil, Qnil);
10785 }
10786
10787 #endif /* HAVE_X_WINDOWS */